blob: b2a3df97ae88184fec9edefa093360aa4e247fa0 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau09cc6692021-03-19 17:16:18 +01007 2021/03/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132
1331. Quick reminder about HTTP
134----------------------------
135
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
138on almost anything found in the contents.
139
140However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
141formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
142correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
143
144
1451.1. The HTTP transaction model
146-------------------------------
147
148The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100149to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100150from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
151connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152will involve a new connection :
153
154 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
155
156In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
157establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
158by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
159length.
160
161Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
162to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
163however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
164response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
165header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
166
167 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
168
169Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
170power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
171but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200172a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100174Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
176second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
177page :
178
179 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
180
181This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
182latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
183correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
184the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100185server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100187The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
188time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
189are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
190parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
191carry the stream identifier.
192
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100193By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
194connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
195leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100196start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
197processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
198waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200199
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200200HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
202 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100203 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200205 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100206
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208
2091.2. HTTP request
210-----------------
211
212First, let's consider this HTTP request :
213
214 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100215 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
217 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
218 3 User-agent: my small browser
219 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
220 5 Accept: image/png
221
222
2231.2.1. The Request line
224-----------------------
225
226Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
227
228 - a METHOD : GET
229 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
230 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
231
232All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
233which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
234followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
235is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
236desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
237the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
238
239The URI itself can have several forms :
240
241 - A "relative URI" :
242
243 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
244
245 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
246 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
247
248 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
249
250 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
251
252 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
253 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
254 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
255 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
256 must accept this form too.
257
258 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
259 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
260 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200262 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
263 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
264 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
265 other protocols too.
266
267In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
268mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
269on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
270It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
271specific to the language, framework or application in use.
272
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100273HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100274assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200276
2771.2.2. The request headers
278--------------------------
279
280The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
281beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
282an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
283Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
284values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
285encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
286the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
287define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
288
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100289Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200290their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100291"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200292as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
293normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
294representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
295HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296
297The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
298that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
299is one valid form of empty line.
300
301Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
302headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
303about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
304application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
305
306Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000307 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
309 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
310 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
311
312
3131.3. HTTP response
314------------------
315
316An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
317messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
318
319 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
322 2 Content-length: 350
323 3 Content-Type: text/html
324
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200325As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
326codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
327response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100328continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
329the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
330following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
331sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
332(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
333correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
334such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
335state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
336over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
337if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
338information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003411.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342------------------------
343
344Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
345
346 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
347 - a status code : 200
348 - a reason : OK
349
350The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100351 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
352 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
353 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
354 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
355 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000357Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100358"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
360messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
361or "Authentication Required".
362
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100363HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364
365 Code When / reason
366 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
367 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100370 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200372 400 for an invalid or too large request
373 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
374 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200375 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100376 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100378 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
379 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
381 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100382 501 when haproxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
383 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100411 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700412 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100413 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200414
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
416a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100417
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
419
420 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
421
422 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
423 tab characters
424
425 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
426 keyword sequences listed in this document
427
428 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
429 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
430 parts of the configuration, or expressions
431
432 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
433 are supported
434
435 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
436 section
437
438This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
439generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
440figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
441
442First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
443the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
444a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
445word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
446follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
447the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
448the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
449the parts that need to be addressed.
450
451A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
452requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
453extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
454the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
455section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
456section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
457not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
458
459A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
460each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
461a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
462start a new one.
463
464Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
465that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
466applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
467"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
468processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
469ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
470which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
471In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
472of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
473identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
474such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4752, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
476
477 listen foo
478 bind :80
479
480 listen bar
481 bind :81
482
483Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
484spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
485of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
486following configurations are strictly equivalent:
487
488 global#this is the global section
489 daemon#daemonize
490 frontend foo
491 mode http # or tcp
492
493and:
494
495 global
496 daemon
497
498 # this is the public web frontend
499 frontend foo
500 mode http
501
502The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
503new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
504other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
505section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
506section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
507at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
508
509Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
510are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
511editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
512support automatic indent.
513
514In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
515positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
516modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
517anymore, and is not recommended.
518
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200519
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005202.2. Quoting and escaping
521-------------------------
522
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100523In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
524that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
525possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
526in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
527('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200528
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100529This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
530very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
531the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
532also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
533delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
534word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
535remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200536
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100537If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
538(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
539
540Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
541backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200542
543 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
544 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
545 \\ to use a backslash
546 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
547 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
548
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100549In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
550C-language representation:
551
552 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
553 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
554 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
555 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
556
557Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
558or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
559of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200560
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100561 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200562 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
563 # hash as a comment start
564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
566evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
567dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
568backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
571character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
572is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
575entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
576name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
577represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
578hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200579
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100580 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
581 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
582 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
583 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
584 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
585 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
586 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
587 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
588 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
589 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
590 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200591
592 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100593 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200594 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
595 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
596 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
597 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
598 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
599
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100600There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
601necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
602by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
603they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
604escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
605characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
606case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
607if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
608own quotes.
609
610The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
611quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500612not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100613quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
614
615Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
616arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
617
618 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
619 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
620
621Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
622"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
623cannot write:
624
625 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
626
627because we would like the string to cut like this:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630 |---------|----|-|
631 arg1 _/ / /
632 arg2 __________/ /
633 arg3 ______________/
634
635but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
636parenthesis then garbage:
637
638 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
639 |--------|--------|
640 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
641 trailing garbage _________/
642
643The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
644quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
645processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
646this word:
647
648 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
649 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
650 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
651
652So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
653still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
654the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
655the second level:
656
657 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
658 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
659 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
660 |---------||----|-|
661 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
662 arg2=blah ___________/ /
663 arg3=g _______________/
664
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500665Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100666double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
667
668 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
669 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
670 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
671 |---------||----|-|
672 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
673 arg2 ___________/ /
674 arg3 _______________/
675
676When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
677appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
678string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
679thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
680
681 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
682 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
683 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
684 |-------------| |-----||-|
685 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
686 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
687 arg3 ______________________/
688
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500689Remember that backslahes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100690that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
691quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
692single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
693level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
694
695When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
696double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
697and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
698a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
699a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
700the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
701regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
702around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
703more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200704
705
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007062.3. Environment variables
707--------------------------
708
709HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
710interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
711configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
712optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
713shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200714underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
715list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
716arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
717before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200718
719 Example:
720
721 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
722
723 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
724
725 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
726
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200727Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
728file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200729
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200730* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
731 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
732
733* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
734 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
735 directory.
736
737* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
738
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500739* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200740 processes, separated by semicolons.
741
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500742* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200743 CLI, separated by semicolons.
744
745See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200746
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100747
7482.4. Conditional blocks
749-----------------------
750
751It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
752some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
753ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
754configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
755versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
756preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
757text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
758lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
759switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
760are defined to form conditional blocks:
761
762 - .if <condition>
763 - .elif <condition>
764 - .else
765 - .endif
766
767The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
768as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
769matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
770there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
771only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
772".elif" of a block.
773
774Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
775ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
776as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
777
778The conditions are currently limited to:
779
780 - an empty string, always returns "false"
781 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
782 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
783
784Other patterns are not supported yet but the purpose is to bring a few
785functions to test for certain build options and supported features.
786
787Three other directives are provided to report some status:
788
789 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
790 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
791 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
792
793Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
794"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
795fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
796provide advice to the user.
797
798Example:
799
800 .if "${A}"
801 .if "${B}"
802 .notice "A=1, B=1"
803 .elif "${C}"
804 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
805 .elif "${D}"
806 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
807 .else
808 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
809 .endif
810 .else
811 .notice "A=0"
812 .endif
813
814
8152.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200816----------------
817
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100818Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100819values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
820otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
821numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
822for every keyword. Supported units are :
823
824 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
825 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
826 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
827 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
828 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
829 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
830
831
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01008322.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200833-------------
834
835 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
836 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
837 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
838 global
839 daemon
840 maxconn 256
841
842 defaults
843 mode http
844 timeout connect 5000ms
845 timeout client 50000ms
846 timeout server 50000ms
847
848 frontend http-in
849 bind *:80
850 default_backend servers
851
852 backend servers
853 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
854
855
856 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
857 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
858 global
859 daemon
860 maxconn 256
861
862 defaults
863 mode http
864 timeout connect 5000ms
865 timeout client 50000ms
866 timeout server 50000ms
867
868 listen http-in
869 bind *:80
870 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
871
872
873Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
874
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100875 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200876
877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008783. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200879--------------------
880
881Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
882are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
883of them have command-line equivalents.
884
885The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
886
887 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200888 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200889 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200890 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200891 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200892 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200893 - description
894 - deviceatlas-json-file
895 - deviceatlas-log-level
896 - deviceatlas-separator
897 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900898 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200899 - gid
900 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100901 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200902 - h1-case-adjust
903 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100904 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100905 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100906 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200907 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200908 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200909 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100910 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200911 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100912 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100913 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200914 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200915 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200916 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200917 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200918 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200919 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100920 - presetenv
921 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200922 - uid
923 - ulimit-n
924 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200925 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100926 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200927 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200928 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200929 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200930 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200931 - ssl-default-bind-options
932 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200933 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200934 - ssl-default-server-options
935 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100936 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200937 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100938 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100939 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100940 - 51degrees-data-file
941 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200942 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200943 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200944 - wurfl-data-file
945 - wurfl-information-list
946 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200947 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100948 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100949
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200950 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100951 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200952 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200953 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200954 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100955 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100956 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100957 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200958 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200959 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200960 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200961 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200962 - noepoll
963 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000964 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100966 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300967 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000968 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100969 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200970 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200971 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200972 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000973 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000974 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200975 - tune.buffers.limit
976 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200977 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200978 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100979 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200980 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200981 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200982 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200983 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100984 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200985 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200986 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200987 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100988 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100989 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100990 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100991 - tune.lua.session-timeout
992 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200993 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100994 - tune.maxaccept
995 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200996 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200997 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200998 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200999 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1000 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001001 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1002 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001003 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001004 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001005 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001006 - tune.sndbuf.client
1007 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001008 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001009 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001010 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001011 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001012 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001013 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001014 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001015 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001016 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001017 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001018 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1019 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1020 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001021 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1022 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001023
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001024 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001025 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001026 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001027
1028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010293.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001030------------------------------------
1031
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001032ca-base <dir>
1033 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001034 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1035 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1036 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001037
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001038chroot <jail dir>
1039 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1040 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1041 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1042 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1043 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001044 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001045
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001046cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1047 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1048 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1049 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1050 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1051 set. These sets have the format
1052
1053 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1054
1055 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001056 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001057 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1058 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001059 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1060 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001061 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001062 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001063 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001064 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001065 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
1066 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
1067 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
1068 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001069
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001070 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1071 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1072 on the machine's word size.
1073
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001074 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001075 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1076 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1077 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1078 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1079 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1080 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001081
1082 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001083 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1084
1085 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1086 # first 4 CPUs
1087
1088 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1089 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1090 # word size.
1091
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001092 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001093 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001094 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1095 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1096 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1097
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001098 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1099 # and so on.
1100 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1101 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1102 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1103
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001104 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001105 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1106 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1107 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1108
1109 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1110 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1111 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1112
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001113 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1114 # and a thread range.
1115 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1116 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1117 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1118
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001119crt-base <dir>
1120 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001121 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1122 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001123
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001124daemon
1125 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1126 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001127 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1128 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001129
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001130deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1131 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001132 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001133
1134deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001135 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001136 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1137
1138deviceatlas-separator <char>
1139 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1140 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1141
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001142deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001143 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1144 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1145 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001146
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001147external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001148 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1149 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001150 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1151 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1152 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1153 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1154 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001155
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001156gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001157 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001158 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1159 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001160 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1161 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001162 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001163
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001164group <group name>
1165 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1166 See also "gid" and "user".
1167
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001168hard-stop-after <time>
1169 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1170
1171 Arguments :
1172 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1173 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1174 SIGUSR1 signal.
1175
1176 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1177 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1178 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1179
1180 Example:
1181 global
1182 hard-stop-after 30s
1183
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001184h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1185 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1186 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1187 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1188 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001189 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001190 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1191 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1192 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1193 specified in a proxy.
1194
1195 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1196 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1197 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1198 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1199 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1200 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1201 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1202
1203 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1204 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1205 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1206 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1207 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1208
1209 Example:
1210 global
1211 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1212
1213 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1214 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1215
1216h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1217 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1218 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1219 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1220 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1221 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1222 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1223 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1224 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1225
1226 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1227 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1228 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1229
1230 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1231 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1232
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001233insecure-fork-wanted
1234 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1235 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1236 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1237 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1238 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1239 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1240 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1241 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1242 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1243 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1244 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1245 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1246 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1247 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1248 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1249 disable it.
1250
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001251insecure-setuid-wanted
1252 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1253 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1254 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1255 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1256 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1257 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1258 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1259 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1260 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1261 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1262 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1263 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1264 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1265 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1266
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001267issuers-chain-path <dir>
1268 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1269 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1270 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1271 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1272 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1273 "issuers-chain-path".
1274 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1275 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1276 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1277 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1278 will share the chain in memory.
1279
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001280localpeer <name>
1281 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1282 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1283 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1284 the configuration parsing.
1285
1286 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1287 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1288
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001289log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001290 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001291 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001292 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001293 configured with "log global".
1294
1295 <address> can be one of:
1296
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001297 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001298 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1299 port).
1300
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001301 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1302 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1303 port).
1304
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001305 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001306 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1307 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001308 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001309
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001310 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1311 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1312 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1313 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1314 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1315 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1316 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1317 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1318 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1319 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1320 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1321 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1322 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1323 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001324 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1325 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001326
1327 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1328 "fd@2", see above.
1329
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001330 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1331 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1332 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1333 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1334 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1335
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001336 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1337 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001338
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001339 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1340 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1341 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1342 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1343 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1344 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1345 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1346 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1347 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1348 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001349 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1350 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001351
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001352 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1353 one of the following :
1354
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001355 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1356 field is stripped. This is the default.
1357 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1358 rfc3164.
1359
1360 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001361 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1362
1363 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1364 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1365
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001366 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1367 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1368 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1369 designed to be used with a local log server.
1370
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001371 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1372 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1373 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1374 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1375 logger consumes.
1376
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001377 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1378 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1379 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1380 used with a local log server.
1381
1382 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1383 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1384 designed to be used with a local log server.
1385
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001386 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1387 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1388 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1389 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1390
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001391 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1392 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1393 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1394 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1395 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1396
1397 <sample_size>
1398 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1399 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1400 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1401 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1402 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1403
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001404 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001405
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001406 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1407 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1408 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1409
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001410 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1411 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1412 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1413 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001414
1415 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001416 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1417 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1418 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1419 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1420 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1421 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001422
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001423 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001424
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001425log-send-hostname [<string>]
1426 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1427 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1428 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1429 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1430 the logs.
1431
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001432log-tag <string>
1433 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1434 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1435 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001436 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001437
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001438lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001439 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1440 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1441 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1442 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1443 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1444 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001445 used multiple times.
1446
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001447lua-load-per-thread <file>
1448 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1449 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1450 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1451 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1452 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1453 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1454 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1455 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1456 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1457 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1458 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1459 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1460 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1461 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1462 times.
1463
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001464lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1465 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1466 variable.
1467 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1468 to "path".
1469
1470 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1471 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1472 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1473 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1474 will be checked earlier.
1475
1476 As an example by specifying the following path:
1477
1478 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1479 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1480
1481 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1482 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1483 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1484 paths if that does not exist either.
1485
1486 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1487 documentation.
1488
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001489master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001490 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1491 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1492 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001493 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001494 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1495 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001496 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1497 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1498 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1499 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1500 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001501
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001502 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001503
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001504mworker-max-reloads <number>
1505 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001506 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001507 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1508 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1509 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1510
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001511nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001512 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1513 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1514 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001515 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1516 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001517 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1518 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1519 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001520
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001521nbthread <number>
1522 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001523 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1524 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1525 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1526 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1527 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001528 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1529 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1530 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1531 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1532 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1533 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1534 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001535
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001536pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001537 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1538 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1539 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1540 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001541
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001542pp2-never-send-local
1543 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1544 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1545 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1546 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1547 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1548 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1549 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1550 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1551 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1552 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1553 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1554
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001555presetenv <name> <value>
1556 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1557 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1558 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1559 and "unsetenv".
1560
1561resetenv [<name> ...]
1562 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1563 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1564 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1565 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1566 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1567 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1568 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1569 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1570
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001571stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001572 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1573 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1574 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1575 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1576 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1577 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001578 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001579 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1580 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1581 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1582 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001583
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001584server-state-base <directory>
1585 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001586 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1587 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001588
1589server-state-file <file>
1590 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1591 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1592 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1593 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1594 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1595 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1596 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1597 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001598 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1599 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001600
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001601setenv <name> <value>
1602 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1603 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1604 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1605 and "unsetenv".
1606
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001607set-dumpable
1608 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001609 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1610 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1611 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1612 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1613 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1614 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1615 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1616 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1617 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1618 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1619 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1620 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1621 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1622 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1623 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1624 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1625 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001626
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001627ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1628 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1629 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001630 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001631 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001632 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1633 information and recommendations see e.g.
1634 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1635 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1636 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1637 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001638
1639ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1640 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1641 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1642 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1643 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1644 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001645 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1646 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1647 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001648 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001649
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001650ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1651 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1652 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1653 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1654 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1655 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1656
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001657ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1658 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1659 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1660 keyword to see available options.
1661
1662 Example:
1663 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001664 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001665
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001666ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1668 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001669 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001670 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001671 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1672 information and recommendations see e.g.
1673 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1674 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1675 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1676 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1677 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001678
1679ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1680 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1681 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1682 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1683 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1684 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001685 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1686 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1687 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1688 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001689
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001690ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1691 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1692 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1693 keyword to see available options.
1694
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001695ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1696 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1697 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1698 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001699 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001700 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001701 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1702 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1703 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1704 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001705 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1706 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1707 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1708
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001709ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1710 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1711 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001712 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001713 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001714 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1715
1716 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001717
1718 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1719 and won't try to remove them.
1720
1721 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1722
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001723ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001724 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001725 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1726 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001727
1728 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1729 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1730 optimize the startup time.
1731
1732 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1733 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1734 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1735
1736 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001737 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001738
1739 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001740 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1741
1742 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1743 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1744 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1745 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1746 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1747 bind configuration..
1748
1749 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1750 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1751 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1752 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1753 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1754 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1755 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1756 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1757
1758 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1759
1760 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1761 a cert bundle.
1762
1763 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1764 separately in several "crt".
1765
1766 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1767 since files are loading separately.
1768
1769 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1770 required to commit them.
1771
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001772 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001773 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001774
1775 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1776
1777 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1778
1779 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1780 not provided in the PEM file.
1781
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001782 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1783 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1784
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001785 The default behavior is "all".
1786
1787 Example:
1788 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1789 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1790 ssl-load-extra-files none
1791
1792 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1793
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001794ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1795 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1796 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1797 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1798
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001799ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001800 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001801 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1802 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1803 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1804 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1805 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1806 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001807 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001808
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001809stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1810 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1811 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1812 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001813 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001814 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001815
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001816 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1817 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1818 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001819
1820stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1821 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1822 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001823 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001824
1825stats maxconn <connections>
1826 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1827 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1828
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001829uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001830 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001831 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1832 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1833 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1834
1835ulimit-n <number>
1836 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1837 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1838 option.
1839
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001840unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1841 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1842
1843 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1844 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1845 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1846 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1847 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1848 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1849 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1850 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1851 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1852 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1853
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001854unsetenv [<name> ...]
1855 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1856 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1857 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1858 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1859 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1860 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1861 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1862
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001863user <user name>
1864 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1865 See also "uid" and "group".
1866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001867node <name>
1868 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1869
1870 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1871 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1872 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1873 traffic.
1874
1875description <text>
1876 Add a text that describes the instance.
1877
1878 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1879 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1880 "<" and ">" characters.
1881
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100188251degrees-data-file <file path>
1883 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001884 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001885
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001886 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001887 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1888
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000188951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001890 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1891 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1892 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1893
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001894 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001895 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1896
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200189751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001898 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1899 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1900
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001901 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1902 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1903
190451degrees-cache-size <number>
1905 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1906 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1907 By default, this cache is disabled.
1908
1909 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001910 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1911
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001912wurfl-data-file <file path>
1913 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1914 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1915
1916 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1917 with USE_WURFL=1.
1918
1919wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1920 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1921 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1922 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1923
1924 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1925
1926 Valid WURFL properties are:
1927 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1928
1929 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1930 device.
1931
1932 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1933 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1934
1935 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1936 particular web request.
1937
1938 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1939 used Libwurfl API version.
1940
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001941 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1942 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1943
1944 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1945 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1946
1947 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1948
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001949 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1950 with USE_WURFL=1.
1951
1952wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1953 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1954 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1955
1956 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1957 with USE_WURFL=1.
1958
1959wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1960 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1961 thus before the chroot.
1962
1963 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1964 with USE_WURFL=1.
1965
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001966wurfl-cache-size <size>
1967 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1968 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001969 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001970 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001971
1972 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1973 with USE_WURFL=1.
1974
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001975strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001976 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1977 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1978 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1979 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1980 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019823.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001983-----------------------
1984
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001985busy-polling
1986 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1987 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1988 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1989 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1990 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1991 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1992 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1993 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1994 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1995 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1996 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1997 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1998 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1999 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2000 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2001 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2002 "poll" pollers.
2003
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002004 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2005 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2006 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2007
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002008max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
2009 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
2010 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2011 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2012 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2013 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2014 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2015 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2016 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2017
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002018maxconn <number>
2019 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2020 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2021 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002022 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2023 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2024 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2025 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002026 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2027 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2028 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2029 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2030 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2031 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002032
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002033maxconnrate <number>
2034 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2035 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2036 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2037 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2038 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2039 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2040 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2041 fairness.
2042
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002043maxcomprate <number>
2044 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002045 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002046 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2047 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2048 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002049 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002050 default value.
2051
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002052maxcompcpuusage <number>
2053 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2054 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2055 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2056 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
2057 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2058 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2059 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2060 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2061
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002062maxpipes <number>
2063 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2064 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2065 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2066 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2067 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2068 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2069
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002070maxsessrate <number>
2071 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2072 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2073 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2074 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2075 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2076 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2077 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2078 fairness.
2079
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002080maxsslconn <number>
2081 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2082 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2083 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2084 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2085 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2086 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2087 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002088 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2089 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2090 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2091 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2092 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2093 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2094 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002095
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002096maxsslrate <number>
2097 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2098 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2099 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2100 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2101 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2102 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2103 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2104 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2105 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2106 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2107
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002108maxzlibmem <number>
2109 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2110 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2111 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002112 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2113 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2114 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2115
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002116noepoll
2117 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2118 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002119 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002120
2121nokqueue
2122 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2123 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2124 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2125
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002126noevports
2127 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2128 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2129 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2130 also "nopoll".
2131
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002132nopoll
2133 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2134 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002135 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002136 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2137 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002138
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002139nosplice
2140 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002141 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002142 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002143 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002144 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2145 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2146 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2147 "option splice-response".
2148
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002149nogetaddrinfo
2150 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2151 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2152
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002153noreuseport
2154 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2155 command line argument "-dR".
2156
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002157profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2158 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2159 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2160 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2161 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002162 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002163 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2164 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2165 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2166 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2167
2168 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2169 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2170 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2171 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2172 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002173 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2174 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2175 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2176 CLI.
2177
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002178spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002179 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2180 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2181 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2182 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2183 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2184 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002185
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002186ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002187 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002188 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002189 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2190 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2191 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2192 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2193 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002194 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2195 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002196 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2197 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2198 openssl configuration file uses:
2199 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2200
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002201ssl-mode-async
2202 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002203 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002204 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2205 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2206 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002207 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002208 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002209
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002210tune.buffers.limit <number>
2211 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2212 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2213 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2214 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2215 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002216 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002217 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2218 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2219 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2220 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2221 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2222 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2223 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2224 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2225 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2226
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002227tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2228 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2229 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2230 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2231 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2232
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002233tune.bufsize <number>
2234 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2235 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2236 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2237 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2238 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2239 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2240 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002241 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2242 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2243 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002244 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002245 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2246 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2247 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002248
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002249tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2250 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002251
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002252tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2253 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2254 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2255 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2256 this value. The default value is 1.
2257
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002258tune.fail-alloc
2259 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2260 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2261 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2262 gracefully.
2263
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002264tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2265 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2266 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2267 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2268 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2269 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2270
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002271tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2272 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2273 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2274 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2275 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2276 change it.
2277
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002278tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2279 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002280 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2281 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002282 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2283 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2284 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2285 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2286 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2287
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002288tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2289 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2290 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2291 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2292 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2293 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2294 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2295 recommended not to change this value.
2296
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002297tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2298 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2299 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2300 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2301 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2302 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2303 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2304 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2305
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002306tune.http.cookielen <number>
2307 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2308 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2309 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2310 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2311 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2312 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2313 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2314 to change this value.
2315
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002316tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002317 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2318 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002319 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002320 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002321 configuration directives too.
2322 The default value is 1024.
2323
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002324tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2325 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2326 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2327 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2328 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2329 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2330 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002331 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2332 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2333 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002334
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002335tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2336 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2337 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2338 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2339 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2340 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2341 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002342 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2343 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2344 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2345 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2346 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002347
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002348tune.idletimer <timeout>
2349 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2350 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2351 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2352 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2353 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2354 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002355 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002356 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002357 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2358
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002359tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2360 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2361 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2362 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2363 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2364 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2365 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2366 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2367 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2368 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2369
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002370tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2371 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002372 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002373 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2374 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002375 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002376 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2377 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2378
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002379tune.lua.maxmem
2380 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2381 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2382 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2383 memory.
2384
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002385tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2386 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002387 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2388 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002389 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002390
2391tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2392 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2393 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2394 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2395 check servers.
2396
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002397tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2398 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2399 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2400 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002401 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002402
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002403tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002404 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2405 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002406 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2407 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2408 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2409 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2410 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2411 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2412 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2413 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2414 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002415
2416tune.maxpollevents <number>
2417 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2418 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2419 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2420 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2421 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2422
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002423tune.maxrewrite <number>
2424 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2425 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2426 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2427 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2428 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2429 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2430 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2431 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2432 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2433 bufsize.
2434
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002435tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2436 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2437 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2438 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2439 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2440 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2441 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2442 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2443 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2444 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002445 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2446 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002447 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2448 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2449 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2450 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2451 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2452 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2453 setting this parameter to 0.
2454
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002455tune.pipesize <number>
2456 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2457 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2458 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2459 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2460 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2461 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2462
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002463tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2464 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2465 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2466 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2467 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2468 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2469 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002470 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002471
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002472tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2473 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2474 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2475 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2476 default is 20.
2477
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002478tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2479tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2480 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2481 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2482 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002483 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002484 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002485 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2486 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2487
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002488tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002489 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002490 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2491 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2492 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2493 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2494
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002495tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002496 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002497 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2498 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2499 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2500 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2501 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2502 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2503 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002504
2505tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2506 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2507 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2508 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2509 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2510 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2511 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2512 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2513 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2514 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002515
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002516tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2517tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2518 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2519 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2520 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002521 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002522 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002523 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2524 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2525 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2526 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2527 notifying haproxy again.
2528
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002529tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002530 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002531 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2532 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2533 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2534 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2535 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2536 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2537 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2538 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2539 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2540 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2541 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002542
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002543tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002544 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002545 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2546 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2547 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2548 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2549 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2550
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002551tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2552 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2553 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2554 performances. This is disabled by default.
2555
2556 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2557 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2558
2559 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2560
2561 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2562
2563 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2564
2565 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2566 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2567 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2568
2569 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2570 converted.
2571
2572 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2573 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2574 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2575 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2576 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2577 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2578 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002579 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2580 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002581
2582 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2583
2584 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2585 only need this line:
2586
2587 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2588
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002589tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2590 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002591 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002592 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2593 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2594 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2595 being used for too long.
2596
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002597tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2598 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2599 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2600 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2601 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2602 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2603 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2604 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2605 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2606 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2607 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002608 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002609 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002610
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002611tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2612 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2613 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2614 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2615 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002616 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002617 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2618 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002619 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2620 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002621
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002622tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2623 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2624 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2625 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2626 1000 entries.
2627
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002628tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2629 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2630 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2631 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2632
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002633tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002634tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002635tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2636tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2637tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002638 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2639 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2640 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2641 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2642 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2643 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2644 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2645 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002646
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002647 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2648 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2649 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2650 all available space is consumed.
2651 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2652 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2653 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002654
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002655tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2656 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002657 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002658 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002659 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002660 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2661
2662tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2663 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2664 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002665 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2666 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002667
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026683.3. Debugging
2669--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002670
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002671quiet
2672 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2673 line argument "-q".
2674
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002675zero-warning
2676 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2677 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2678 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2679 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2680 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2681 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2682
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002683
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010026843.4. Userlists
2685--------------
2686It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2687http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2688it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2689
2690userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002691 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002692 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2693
2694group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002695 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002696 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2697 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2698
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002699user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2700 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002701 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2702 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002703 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2704 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2705 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2706 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002707
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002708 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2709 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2710 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2711 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2712 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2713 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2714 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2715 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2716 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002717
2718 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002719 userlist L1
2720 group G1 users tiger,scott
2721 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002722
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002723 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2724 user scott insecure-password elgato
2725 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002726
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002727 userlist L2
2728 group G1
2729 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002730
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002731 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2732 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2733 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002734
2735 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002736
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002737
27383.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002739----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002740It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2741several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2742instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2743values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2744automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2745In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2746using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2747tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2748reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2749Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2750that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2751each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002752
2753peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002754 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002755 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2756
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002757bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2758 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2759 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2760
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002761disabled
2762 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2763 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2764 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2765
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002766default-bind [param*]
2767 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2768
2769default-server [param*]
2770 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2771
2772 Arguments:
2773 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2774 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2775 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2776 details.
2777
2778
2779 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2780
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002781enable
2782 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2783
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002784log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002785 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2786 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2787 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2788 more details.
2789
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002790peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002791 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2792 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002793 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2794 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2795 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2796 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2797 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002798
2799 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2800 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2801
2802 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002803 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2804 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2805 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002806
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002807 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2808 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002809
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002810 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2811 "server" keyword explanation below).
2812
2813server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002814 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002815 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2816 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2817 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2818 of this "peers" section).
2819 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2820
2821
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002822 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002823 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002824 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002825 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2826 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2827 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002828
2829 backend mybackend
2830 mode tcp
2831 balance roundrobin
2832 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2833 stick on src
2834
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002835 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2836 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002837
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002838 Example:
2839 peers mypeers
2840 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2841 default-server ssl verify none
2842 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2843 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002844
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002845
2846table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2847 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2848
2849 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2850 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002851 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002852 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2853 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2854 "stick-table" keyword).
2855
2856 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2857 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2858 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2859 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2860 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2861 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2862 of the stick-table name as follows:
2863
2864 peers mypeers
2865 peer A ...
2866 peer B ...
2867 table t1 ...
2868
2869 frontend fe1
2870 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2871
2872 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2873 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2874
2875 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2876 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2877 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2878 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2879 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2880 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2881 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2882
2883 peers mypeers
2884 peer A ...
2885 peer B ...
2886 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2887
2888 backend t1
2889 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2890
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002891 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002892 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2893 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2894
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090028953.6. Mailers
2896------------
2897It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2898If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2899in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2900
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002901mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002902 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2903 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2904
2905mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2906 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2907
2908 Example:
2909 mailers mymailers
2910 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2911 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2912
2913 backend mybackend
2914 mode tcp
2915 balance roundrobin
2916
2917 email-alert mailers mymailers
2918 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2919 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2920
2921 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2922 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2923
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002924timeout mail <time>
2925 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2926 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2927 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2928 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2929
2930 Example:
2931 mailers mymailers
2932 timeout mail 20s
2933 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002934
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020029353.7. Programs
2936-------------
2937In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2938master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2939managed the same way as the workers.
2940
2941During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2942sequence as a worker:
2943
2944 - the master is re-executed
2945 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2946 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2947 instance of the program
2948
2949During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2950
2951program <name>
2952 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2953 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2954 the management guide).
2955
2956command <command> [arguments*]
2957 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2958 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2959 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2960 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2961
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002962user <user name>
2963 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2964 See also "group".
2965
2966group <group name>
2967 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2968 See also "user".
2969
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002970option start-on-reload
2971no option start-on-reload
2972 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2973 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2974 program section.
2975
2976
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010029773.8. HTTP-errors
2978----------------
2979
2980It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2981imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2982several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2983
2984http-errors <name>
2985 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2986 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2987
2988errorfile <code> <file>
2989 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2990
2991 Arguments :
2992 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002993 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01002994 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002995
2996 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2997 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2998 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2999 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3000 before any chroot is performed.
3001
3002 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3003
3004 Example:
3005 http-errors website-1
3006 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3007 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3008 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3009
3010 http-errors website-2
3011 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3012 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3013 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3014
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020030153.9. Rings
3016----------
3017
3018It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3019servers or traces.
3020
3021ring <ringname>
3022 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3023
3024description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003025 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003026 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3027
3028format <format>
3029 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3030
3031 Arguments:
3032 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3033 one of the following :
3034
3035 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3036 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3037 designed to be used with a local log server.
3038
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003039 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3040 field is stripped. This is the default.
3041 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3042 rfc3164.
3043
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003044 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3045 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3046 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3047 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3048 is the default.
3049
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003050 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003051 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3052
3053 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3054 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3055
3056 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3057 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3058 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3059 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3060 logger consumes.
3061
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003062 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3063 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3064 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3065 with a local log server.
3066
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003067 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3068 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3069 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3070 used with a local log server.
3071
3072maxlen <length>
3073 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3074 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3075 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3076
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003077server <name> <address> [param*]
3078 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3079 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3080 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3081 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3082 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3083 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3084 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3085 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3086 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003087 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3088 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003089
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003090size <size>
3091 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3092 set to BUFSIZE.
3093
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003094timeout connect <timeout>
3095 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3096
3097 Arguments :
3098 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3099 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3100 as explained at the top of this document.
3101
3102timeout server <timeout>
3103 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3104
3105 Arguments :
3106 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3107 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3108 as explained at the top of this document.
3109
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003110 Example:
3111 global
3112 log ring@myring local7
3113
3114 ring myring
3115 description "My local buffer"
3116 format rfc3164
3117 maxlen 1200
3118 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003119 timeout connect 5s
3120 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003121 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003122
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020031233.10. Log forwarding
3124-------------------
3125
3126It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3127haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3128
3129log-forward <name>
3130 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3131
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003132backlog <conns>
3133 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3134 on connections accept.
3135
3136bind <addr> [param*]
3137 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003138 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3139 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3140 syslog protocol over TCP.
3141 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003142 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3143
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003144dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003145 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3146 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3147 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3148 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003149 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003150
3151log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003152log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003153 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3154 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3155 documentation.
3156 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3157 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3158 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3159 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3160 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3161
3162 Example:
3163 global
3164 log stderr format iso local7
3165
3166 ring myring
3167 description "My local buffer"
3168 format rfc5424
3169 maxlen 1200
3170 size 32764
3171 timeout connect 5s
3172 timeout server 10s
3173 # syslog tcp server
3174 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3175
3176 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003177 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3178 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003179 # all messages on stderr
3180 log global
3181 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3182 log ring@myring local0
3183 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3184 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3185 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3186 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3187 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003188
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003189maxconn <conns>
3190 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3191 10 is the default.
3192
3193timeout client <timeout>
3194 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3195
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031964. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003197----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003198
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003199Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003200 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3201 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3202 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3203 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003204
3205A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3206connections.
3207
3208A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3209to forward incoming connections.
3210
3211A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3212parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3213
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003214A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3215ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3216sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3217the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3218explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3219from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3220"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3221for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3222to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3223optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3224are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3225any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3226names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3227that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3228duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3229names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3230
3231Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3232settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3233of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3234profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3235timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3236
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003237All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3238'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3239case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3240
3241Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3242logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3243proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3244However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3245name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3246
3247Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3248and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003249bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003250protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3251modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3252arbitrary criteria.
3253
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003254In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3255a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003256the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003257
3258 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3259 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3260 between responses and new requests.
3261
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003262 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3263 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3264 client-facing connection remains open.
3265
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003266 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3267 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003268
3269The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3270frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3271following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003272weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003273
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003274 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003275
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003276 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3277 ----+-----+-----+----
3278 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3279 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003280 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3281 ----+-----+-----+----
3282 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003283
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003284
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020032864.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3287--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003289The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3290limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3291they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3292limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003293marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003294option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003295and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3296with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3297specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003298
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003299
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003300 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3301------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3302acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003303backlog X X X -
3304balance X - X X
3305bind - X X -
3306bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003307capture cookie - X X -
3308capture request header - X X -
3309capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003310clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3311clitcpka-idle X X X -
3312clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003313compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003314cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003315declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003316default-server X - X X
3317default_backend X X X -
3318description - X X X
3319disabled X X X X
3320dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003321email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003322email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003323email-alert mailers X X X X
3324email-alert myhostname X X X X
3325email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003326enabled X X X X
3327errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003328errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003329errorloc X X X X
3330errorloc302 X X X X
3331-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3332errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003333force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003334filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003335fullconn X - X X
3336grace X X X X
3337hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003338http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003339http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003340http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003341http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003342http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003343http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003344http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003345http-check set-var X - X X
3346http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003347http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003348http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003349http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003350http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003351http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003352id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003353ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003354load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003355log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003356log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003357log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003358log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003359max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003360maxconn X X X -
3361mode X X X X
3362monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003363monitor-uri X X X -
3364option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3365option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3366option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3367option allbackups (*) X - X X
3368option checkcache (*) X - X X
3369option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3370option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003371option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003372option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3373option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003374-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3375option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003376option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3377option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003378option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003379option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003380option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003381option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003382option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003383option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3384option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3385option httpchk X - X X
3386option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003387option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003388option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003389option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003390option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003391option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003392option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3393option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3394option logasap (*) X X X -
3395option mysql-check X - X X
3396option nolinger (*) X X X X
3397option originalto X X X X
3398option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003399option pgsql-check X - X X
3400option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003401option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003402option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003403option smtpchk X - X X
3404option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3405option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3406option splice-request (*) X X X X
3407option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003408option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003409option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3410option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3411-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003412option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003413option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3414option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3415option tcpka X X X X
3416option tcplog X X X X
3417option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003418external-check command X - X X
3419external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003420persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3421rate-limit sessions X X X -
3422redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003423-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003424retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003425retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003426server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003427server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003428server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003429source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003430srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3431srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3432srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003433stats admin - X X X
3434stats auth X X X X
3435stats enable X X X X
3436stats hide-version X X X X
3437stats http-request - X X X
3438stats realm X X X X
3439stats refresh X X X X
3440stats scope X X X X
3441stats show-desc X X X X
3442stats show-legends X X X X
3443stats show-node X X X X
3444stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003445-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3446stick match - - X X
3447stick on - - X X
3448stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003449stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003450stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003451tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003452tcp-check connect X - X X
3453tcp-check expect X - X X
3454tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003455tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003456tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003457tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003458tcp-check set-var X - X X
3459tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003460tcp-request connection - X X -
3461tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003462tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003463tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003464tcp-response content - - X X
3465tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003466timeout check X - X X
3467timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003468timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003469timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003470timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3471timeout http-request X X X X
3472timeout queue X - X X
3473timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003474timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003475timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003476timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003477transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003478unique-id-format X X X -
3479unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003480use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003481use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003482use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003483------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3484 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003485
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034874.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3488---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003489
3490This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3491
3492
3493acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3494 Declare or complete an access list.
3495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3496 no | yes | yes | yes
3497 Example:
3498 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3499 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3500 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3501
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003502 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003503
3504
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003505backlog <conns>
3506 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3508 yes | yes | yes | no
3509 Arguments :
3510 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3511 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003512 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003513
3514 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3515 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3516 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3517 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3518 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3519 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3520 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3521 backlog parameter.
3522
3523 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3524 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3525 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3526
3527 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3528
3529
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003530balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003531balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003532 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3534 yes | no | yes | yes
3535 Arguments :
3536 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3537 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3538 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3539 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3540
3541 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3542 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3543 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3544 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003545 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003546 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003547 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3548 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3549 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3550 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3551 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3552 it, so that you don't worry.
3553
3554 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3555 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3556 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3557 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3558 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3559 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3560 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3561 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003562
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003563 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3564 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3565 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3566 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3567 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3568 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3569 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003570 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3571 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3572 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003573
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003574 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003575 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003576 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3577 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003578 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003579 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3580 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3581 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3582 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3583 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003584 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3585 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3586 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3587 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3588 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3589 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003591 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3592 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3593 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3594 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3595 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3596 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3597 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3598 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003599 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003600 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003601 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3602 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3603 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003604
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003605 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3606 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3607 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3608 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3609 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3610 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3611 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3612 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3613 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3614 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3615 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3616 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003617
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003618 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003619 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3620 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3621 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3622 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3623 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3624 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3625 URIs start with a leading "/".
3626
3627 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3628 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3629 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3630 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3631
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003632 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3633 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3634 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3635 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3636
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003637 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003638 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3639
3640 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003641 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3642 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003643 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3644 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3645 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3646 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003647 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003648 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3649 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003650
3651 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3652 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3653 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3654 server will receive the request.
3655
3656 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3657 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3658 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3659 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3660 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003661 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3662 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3663 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003664
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003665 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3666 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3667 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3668 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3669 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003670
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003671 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003672 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3673 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3674 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3675
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003676 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3677 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3678 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3679
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003680 random
3681 random(<draws>)
3682 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003683 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3684 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3685 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3686 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003687 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3688 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3689 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3690 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3691 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3692 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3693 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3694 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3695 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3696 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3697 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3698 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3699 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3700 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3701 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3702 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3703 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3704 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3705 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3706 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003707
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003708 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003709 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003710 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3711 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3712 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3713 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3714 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3715 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003716 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003717 used instead.
3718
3719 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3720 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3721 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3722 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3723
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003724 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3725 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3726 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3727
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003728 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003729
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003730 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003731 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3732 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003733
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003734 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3735 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3736 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003737
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003738 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003739 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003740 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3741 NTLM relies on.
3742
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003743 Examples :
3744 balance roundrobin
3745 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003746 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003747 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3748 balance hdr(host)
3749 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003750
3751 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3752 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3753
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003754 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003755 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3756 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3757 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003758 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003759
3760 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3761 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3762 defaults to 16 kB.
3763
3764 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3765 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3766
3767 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3768 Round Robin.
3769
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003770 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003771 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3772 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3773 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3774
3775 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3776
3777 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003778 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003779 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3780 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3781 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003782
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003783 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003784
3785
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003786bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3787bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003788 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3790 no | yes | yes | no
3791 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003792 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3793 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3794 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3795 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003796 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003797 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3798 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3799 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3800 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3801 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3802 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003803 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003804 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3805 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003806 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003807 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3808 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003809 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003810 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3811 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003812 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003813 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3814 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3815 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3816 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3817 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3818 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3819 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003820 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3821 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3822 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003823 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3824 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3825 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3826 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003827 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3828 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3829 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003830
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003831 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3832 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003833 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3834 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3835 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003836 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3837 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3838 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3839 the range.
3840
3841 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3842 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3843 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3844 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3845 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3846 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3847 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003848 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003849 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003850
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003851 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003852 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003853 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3854 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3855 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3856 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3857 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3858 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3859
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003860 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3861 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3862 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3863 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003864
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003865 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3866 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3867 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3868 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3869 in a frontend.
3870
3871 Example :
3872 listen http_proxy
3873 bind :80,:443
3874 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003875 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003876
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003877 listen http_https_proxy
3878 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003879 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003880
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003881 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3882 bind ipv6@:80
3883 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3884 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3885
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003886 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003887 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003888
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003889 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3890 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3891 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3892 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3893 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3894
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003895 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003896 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003897
3898
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003899bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003900 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3902 yes | yes | yes | yes
3903 Arguments :
3904 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3905 may be used to override a default value.
3906
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003907 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003908 option may be combined with other numbers.
3909
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003910 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003911 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3912 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3913 missing from all processes.
3914
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003915 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003916 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003917 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3918 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3919 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3920 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3921 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003922 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003923
3924 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3925 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3926 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3927 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3928 and 'even' instances.
3929
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003930 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3931 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3932 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3933 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003934
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003935 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3936 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3937
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003938 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3939 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3940 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3941
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003942 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3943 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3944
3945 Example :
3946 listen app_ip1
3947 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003948 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003949
3950 listen app_ip2
3951 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003952 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003953
3954 listen management
3955 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003956 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003957
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003958 listen management
3959 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3960 bind-process 1-4
3961
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003962 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003963
3964
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003965capture cookie <name> len <length>
3966 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3968 no | yes | yes | no
3969 Arguments :
3970 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3971 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3972 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3973 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003974 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003975
3976 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3977 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3978 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3979 right if it exceeds <length>.
3980
3981 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3982 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3983 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3984 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3985
3986 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3987 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3988 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3989
3990 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3991 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3992 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003993 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3994 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3995 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003996
3997 Example:
3998 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3999
4000 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004001 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004002
4003
4004capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004005 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4007 no | yes | yes | no
4008 Arguments :
4009 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004010 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004011 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4012 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4013 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4014
4015 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4016 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4017 it exceeds <length>.
4018
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004019 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004020 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4021 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004022 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4023 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4024 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4025 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004026 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004027 environments to find where the request came from.
4028
4029 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4030 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4031 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4032 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004033
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004034 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4035 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4036 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4037 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4038 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004039
4040 Example:
4041 capture request header Host len 15
4042 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004043 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004045 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004046 about logging.
4047
4048
4049capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004050 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4052 no | yes | yes | no
4053 Arguments :
4054 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004055 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004056 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4057 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4058 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4059
4060 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4061 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4062 it exceeds <length>.
4063
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004064 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004065 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4066 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4067 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004068 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4069 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4070 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4071 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004072
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004073 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4074 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4075 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4076 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4077 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004078
4079 Example:
4080 capture response header Content-length len 9
4081 capture response header Location len 15
4082
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004083 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004084 about logging.
4085
4086
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004087clitcpka-cnt <count>
4088 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4089 the connection on the client side.
4090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4091 yes | yes | yes | no
4092 Arguments :
4093 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4094
4095 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4096 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004097 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4098 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004099
4100 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4101
4102
4103clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4104 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4105 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4106 client side.
4107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4108 yes | yes | yes | no
4109 Arguments :
4110 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4111 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4112 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4113 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4114
4115 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4116 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004117 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4118 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004119
4120 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4121
4122
4123clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4124 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4126 yes | yes | yes | no
4127 Arguments :
4128 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4129 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4130 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4131 document.
4132
4133 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4134 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004135 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4136 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004137
4138 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4139
4140
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004141compression algo <algorithm> ...
4142compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004143compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004144 Enable HTTP compression.
4145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4146 yes | yes | yes | yes
4147 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004148 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4149 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4150 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4151
4152 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004153 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4154 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4155 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004156
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004157 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004158 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004159
4160 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4161 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4162 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4163 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4164 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004165 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004166
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004167 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4168 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4169 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4170 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4171 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4172 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4173 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004174 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004175
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004176 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004177 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004178 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4179 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4180 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4181 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4182 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004183
4184 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4185 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4186 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4187 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4188 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004189 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4190 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4191 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4192 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4193 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004194 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4195 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004196
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004197 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004198 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4199 "Accept-Encoding" header
4200 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004201 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004202 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4203 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4204 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4205 "multipart"
4206 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4207 header
4208 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4209 and later
4210 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4211 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004212 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004213
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004214 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004215
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004216 Examples :
4217 compression algo gzip
4218 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004219
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004220
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004221cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004222 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4223 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004224 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004225 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4227 yes | no | yes | yes
4228 Arguments :
4229 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4230 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4231 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4232 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4233 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4234 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004235 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004236 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4237 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4238
4239 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4240 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4241 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4242 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4243 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4244 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004245 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4246 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004247 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004248 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4249 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004250
4251 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004252 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004253
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004254 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004255 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004256 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004257 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004258 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4259 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4260 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4261 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4262 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4263 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4264 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004265
4266 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4267 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4268 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4269 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4270 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4271 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4272 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4273 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4274 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004275 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004276 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4277 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4278 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004279
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004280 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4281 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4282 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004283 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4284 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4285 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4286 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004287 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4288 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4289 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004290
4291 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4292 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4293 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4294 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4295 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4296 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4297 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4298 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4299 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4300
4301 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4302 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4303 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4304 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4305 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4306 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4307 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4308 persistence cookie in the cache.
4309 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4310
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004311 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4312 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4313 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4314 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4315 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004316 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004317 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4318 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4319 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4320 they logout.
4321
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004322 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4323 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4324 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4325 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4326
4327 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4328 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4329 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4330 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4331 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4332 this attribute.
4333
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004334 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004335 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004336 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4337 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4338 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4339 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4340 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4341 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004342
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004343 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4344 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4345 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4346 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4347 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4348 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4349 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4350 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004351 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004352 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4353 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4354 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4355 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4356 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4357 the site.
4358
4359 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4360 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4361 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4362 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4363 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4364 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4365 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4366 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4367 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4368 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4369 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4370 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4371 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004372 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004373 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4374 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4375
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004376 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4377 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4378 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4379 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4380 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4381 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4382
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004383 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4384 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4385 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4386 repeated.
4387
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004388 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4389 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4390 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4391 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004392
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004393 Examples :
4394 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4395 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4396 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004397 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004398
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004399 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004400
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004401
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004402declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4403 Declares a capture slot.
4404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4405 no | yes | yes | no
4406 Arguments:
4407 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4408
4409 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4410 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4411 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4412 for use in the response.
4413
4414 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004415 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004416 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4417
4418
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004419default-server [param*]
4420 Change default options for a server in a backend
4421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4422 yes | no | yes | yes
4423 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004424 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4425 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4426 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4427 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004428
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004429 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004430 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4431
4432 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004433
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004434
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004435default_backend <backend>
4436 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4438 yes | yes | yes | no
4439 Arguments :
4440 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4441
4442 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4443 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4444 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4445 will catch all undetermined requests.
4446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004447 Example :
4448
4449 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4450 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4451 default_backend dynamic
4452
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004453 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004454
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004455
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004456description <string>
4457 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4459 no | yes | yes | yes
4460 Arguments : string
4461
4462 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4463 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4464 it describes.
4465 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4466
4467
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004468disabled
4469 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4471 yes | yes | yes | yes
4472 Arguments : none
4473
4474 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4475 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4476 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4477 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4478 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4479 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4480 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4481
4482 See also : "enabled"
4483
4484
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004485dispatch <address>:<port>
4486 Set a default server address
4487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4488 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004489 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004490
4491 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4492 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4493 during start-up.
4494
4495 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4496 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4497 possible with normal servers.
4498
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004499 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004500 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4501 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4502 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4503 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4504
4505 See also : "server"
4506
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004507
4508dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4509 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4511 yes | no | yes | yes
4512 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4513
4514 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004515 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004516 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4517 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004518 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004519 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004520
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004521enabled
4522 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4524 yes | yes | yes | yes
4525 Arguments : none
4526
4527 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4528 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4529
4530 See also : "disabled"
4531
4532
4533errorfile <code> <file>
4534 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4536 yes | yes | yes | yes
4537 Arguments :
4538 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004539 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004540 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004541
4542 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004543 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004544 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004545 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4546 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004547
4548 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4549 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4550 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4551
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004552 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4553
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004554 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4555 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4556 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4557 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4558 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4559 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4560 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4561 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4562 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004563
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004564 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4565 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4566 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004567 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004568 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4569
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004570 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004571
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004572 Example :
4573 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004574 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004575 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4576 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4577
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004578
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004579errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4580 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4581 section.
4582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4583 yes | yes | yes | yes
4584 Arguments :
4585 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4586
4587 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004588 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004589 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4590 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004591
4592 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4593 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4594 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4595 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4596 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004597 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004598 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4599
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004600 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4601 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004602
4603 Example :
4604 errorfiles generic
4605 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4606
4607
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004608errorloc <code> <url>
4609errorloc302 <code> <url>
4610 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4612 yes | yes | yes | yes
4613 Arguments :
4614 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004615 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004616 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004617
4618 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4619 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4620 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4621 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004622 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004623
4624 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4625 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4626 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4627
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004628 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4629
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004630 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4631 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4632 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4633 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004634 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004635 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4636 request.
4637
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004638 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004639
4640
4641errorloc303 <code> <url>
4642 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4644 yes | yes | yes | yes
4645 Arguments :
4646 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004647 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004648 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004649
4650 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4651 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4652 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4653 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004654 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004655
4656 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4657 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4658 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4659
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004660 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4661
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004662 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4663 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4664 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4665 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004666 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004667
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004668 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004669
4670
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004671email-alert from <emailaddr>
4672 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004673 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004674 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4675 yes | yes | yes | yes
4676
4677 Arguments :
4678
4679 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4680
4681 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4682 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4683
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004684 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004685 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4686 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004687
4688
4689email-alert level <level>
4690 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4691 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4692 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4693 yes | yes | yes | yes
4694
4695 Arguments :
4696
4697 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4698 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4699 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4700
4701 By default level is alert
4702
4703 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4704 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4705 for the proxy.
4706
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004707 Alerts are sent when :
4708
4709 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4710 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4711 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4712 is notice or lower
4713 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4714 and a health check status update occurs
4715
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004716 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4717 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004718 section 3.6 about mailers.
4719
4720
4721email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4722 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4723 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4724 yes | yes | yes | yes
4725
4726 Arguments :
4727
4728 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4729
4730 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4731 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4732
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004733 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4734 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004735
4736
4737email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4738 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4739 mailers.
4740 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4741 yes | yes | yes | yes
4742
4743 Arguments :
4744
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004745 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004746
4747 By default the systems hostname is used.
4748
4749 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4750 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4751 for the proxy.
4752
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004753 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4754 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004755
4756
4757email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004758 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004759 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4760 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4761 yes | yes | yes | yes
4762
4763 Arguments :
4764
4765 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4766
4767 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4768 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4769
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004770 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004771 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4772
4773
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004774force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4775 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4776 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004777 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004778
4779 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4780 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4781 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4782 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4783 marked down for maintenance operations.
4784
4785 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4786 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4787 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4788 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4789 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4790 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4791 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4792 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4793 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4794
4795 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4796 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4797 is used.
4798
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004799 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004800 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004801
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004802
4803filter <name> [param*]
4804 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4806 no | yes | yes | yes
4807 Arguments :
4808 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4809 referenced in section 9.
4810
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004811 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004812 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004813 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4814 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004815
4816 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4817 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4818
4819 Example:
4820 listen
4821 bind *:80
4822
4823 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4824 filter compression
4825 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4826
4827 compression algo gzip
4828 compression offload
4829
4830 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4831
4832 See also : section 9.
4833
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004834
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004835fullconn <conns>
4836 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4838 yes | no | yes | yes
4839 Arguments :
4840 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4841 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4842
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004843 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004844 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004845 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004846 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4847 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4848 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4849 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4850 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004851 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004852
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004853 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4854 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004855 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4856 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4857 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004858
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004859 Example :
4860 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4861 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4862 # connections.
4863 backend dynamic
4864 fullconn 10000
4865 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4866 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4867
4868 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4869
4870
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004871grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004872 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004874 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004875 Arguments :
4876 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4877 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4878 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4879
4880 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4881 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004882 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004883 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4884
4885 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4886 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4887 simplify it.
4888
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004889
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004890hash-balance-factor <factor>
4891 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4893 yes | no | no | yes
4894 Arguments :
4895 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4896 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004897 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004898
4899 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4900 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4901 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4902 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4903 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4904 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4905 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4906
4907 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4908 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4909 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4910 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4911 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4912
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004913 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4914 consistent hashing mechanism.
4915
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004916 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4917
4918
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004919hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004920 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4922 yes | no | yes | yes
4923 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004924 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4925 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004926
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004927 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4928 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4929 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4930 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4931 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4932 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4933 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4934 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4935 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4936 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004937
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004938 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4939 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4940 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4941 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4942 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4943 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4944 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4945 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4946 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4947 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4948 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4949 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4950 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004951 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4952 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004953
4954 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4955
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004956 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004957 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4958 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4959 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004960 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4961 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4962 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004963
4964 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4965 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004966 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4967 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4968 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4969 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4970
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004971 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4972 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4973 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4974 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4975 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4976 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4977 parameter.
4978
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004979 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4980 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4981 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4982 used on strings.
4983
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004984 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4985
4986 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4987 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4988 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4989 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4990 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4991 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4992 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4993 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4994 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4995 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4996 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4997 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004998
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004999 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5000 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5001 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005002
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005003 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005004
5005
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005006http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5007 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5008 ones).
5009
5010 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5011 no | yes | yes | yes
5012
5013 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5014 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5015 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5016 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5017 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5018 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5019
5020 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5021 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5022 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5023
5024 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5025 below.
5026
5027 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5028 instance.
5029
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005030 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5031 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5032 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5033
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005034 Example:
5035 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5036 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5037 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5038
5039http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5040
5041 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5042 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5043 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5044 example, or to pass some internal information.
5045 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5046 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5047 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5048
5049http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5050
5051 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5052 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5053
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005054http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005055
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005056 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5057 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5058 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5059 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5060 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005061
5062http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5063 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5064
5065 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5066
5067 Example:
5068 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5069
5070 # applied to:
5071 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5072
5073 # outputs:
5074 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5075
5076 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5077
5078http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5079 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5080
5081 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5082
5083 Example:
5084 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5085
5086 # applied to:
5087 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5088
5089 # outputs:
5090 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5091
5092http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5093
5094 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5095 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5096 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5097
5098http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5099 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5100
5101 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5102 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5103 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5104 fallback.
5105
5106 Example:
5107 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5108 http-response set-status 431
5109 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5110 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5111
5112http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5113
5114 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5115 inline.
5116
5117 Arguments:
5118 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5119 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5120 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5121 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5122 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5123 (request and response)
5124 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5125 processing
5126 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5127 processing
5128 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5129 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5130 and '_'.
5131
5132 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5133 followed by some converters.
5134
5135 Example:
5136 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5137
5138http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5139
5140 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5141 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5142 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5143 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5144 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005145 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005146 processing.
5147
5148 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5149 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005150 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005151 rules evaluation.
5152
5153http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5154
5155 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5156 details about <var-name>.
5157
5158 Example:
5159 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5160
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005161
5162http-check comment <string>
5163 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5164 it fails.
5165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5166 yes | no | yes | yes
5167
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005168 Arguments :
5169 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5170 rule fails.
5171
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005172 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5173 user-friendly error reporting.
5174
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005175 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005176 "http-check expect".
5177
5178
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005179http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5180 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005181 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005182 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5184 yes | no | yes | yes
5185
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005186 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005187 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5188
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005189 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005190 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005191
5192 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5193 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5194 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5195 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5196
5197 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5198
5199 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5200
5201 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5202
5203 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5204
5205 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5206
5207 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5208 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5209 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5210 is used.
5211
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005212 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5213 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5214 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5215 haproxy -vv.
5216
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005217 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5218
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005219 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5220 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5221 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5222 different ports or with different servers.
5223
5224 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5225 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5226 the port with a "http-check connect".
5227
5228 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5229 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5230 do.
5231
5232 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5233 unset-var or comment rules.
5234
5235 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005236 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5237 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5238 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5239 option httpchk
5240
5241 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005242 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005243 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005244 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005245 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005246 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005247
5248 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5249
5250 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005251
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005252
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005253http-check disable-on-404
5254 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005256 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005257 Arguments : none
5258
5259 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5260 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5261 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5262 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5263 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5264 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5265 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5266 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005267 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5268 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005269 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5270 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5271 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005272
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005273 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005274
5275
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005276http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005277 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5278 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5279 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005280 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005282 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005283
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005284 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005285 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5286
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005287 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5288 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5289 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5290 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5291 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5292 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5293 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5294 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5295 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5296 result is always conclusive.
5297
5298 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5299 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5300 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005301 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5302 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005303 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5304 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005305 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5306 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5307 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005308
5309 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5310 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005311 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5312 supported :
5313 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5314 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005315 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5316 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5317 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5318 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5319 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005320
5321 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5322 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005323 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5324 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5325 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5326 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005327 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5328
5329 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5330 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5331 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5332 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5333
5334 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5335 informational message reported in logs if an error
5336 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5337 log-format string.
5338
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005339 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005340 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5341 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005342 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5343 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5344 details on the supported keywords.
5345
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005346 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5347 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5348 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5349 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005350
5351 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5352 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5353 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5354 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5355 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5356
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005357 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5358 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5359 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5360 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5361 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5362 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5363 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005364
5365 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005366 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005367 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5368 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5369 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5370 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5371
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005372 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5373 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005374 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5375 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5376 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5377 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5378 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5379 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5380 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5381 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005382 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5383 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5384 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5385 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5386 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5387 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5388 insensitive on the header names.
5389
5390 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5391 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5392 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5393 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5394 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5395 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005396
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005397 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005398 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005399 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5400 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5401 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5402 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5403 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005404 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005405 trace).
5406
5407 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005408 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005409 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5410 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5411 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5412 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5413 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005414 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005415
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005416 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5417 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5418 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5419 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5420 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5421 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5422
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005423 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005424 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005425 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5426 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5427 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5428 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5429 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5430 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5431
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005432 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5433 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5434 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5435 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5436 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005437
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005438 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5439 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5440
5441 Examples :
5442 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005443 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005444
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005445 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5446 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5447
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005448 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005449 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005450
5451 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005452 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005453
5454 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005455 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005456
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005457 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005458 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005459
5460
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005461http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005462 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5463 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005464 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5465 health checks.
5466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5467 yes | no | yes | yes
5468 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005469 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5470
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005471 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5472 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5473 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5474 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5475 to invent non-standard ones.
5476
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005477 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5478 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5479 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5480 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5481
5482 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5483 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5484 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5485 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005486
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005487 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005488 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005489 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005490 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5491 to add it.
5492
5493 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5494 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5495 to the log-format rules.
5496
5497 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5498 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5499 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005500
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005501 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5502 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5503 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5504 request.
5505
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005506 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5507 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5508 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005509 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5510 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5511 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5512 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005513 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005514
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005515 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005516 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5517 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005518
5519 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5520 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5521 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5522 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5523 configured request authority.
5524
5525 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5526 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005527
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005528 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005529
5530
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005531http-check send-state
5532 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5534 yes | no | yes | yes
5535 Arguments : none
5536
5537 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5538 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5539 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5540 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5541 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5542
5543 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5544 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5545 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5546 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5547 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005548 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5549 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5550 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5551
5552 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5553 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5554 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5555
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005556 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5557 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5558 checked in multiple backends.
5559
5560 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5561 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5562
5563 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5564 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5565 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5566 one fails.
5567
5568 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5569 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5570 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5571
5572 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5573 server's queue.
5574
5575 Example of a header received by the application server :
5576 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5577 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5578
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005579 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5580 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005581
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005582
5583http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005584 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005585 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5586 yes | no | yes | yes
5587
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005588 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005589 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5590 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5591 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5592 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5593 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5594 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5595 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5596 and '-'.
5597
5598 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5599
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005600 Examples :
5601 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005602
5603
5604http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005605 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005606 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5607 yes | no | yes | yes
5608
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005609 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005610 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5611 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5612 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5613 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5614 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5615 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5616 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5617 and '-'.
5618
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005619 Examples :
5620 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005621
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005622
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005623http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5624 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5625 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5626 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5627 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5629 yes | yes | yes | yes
5630 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005631 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005632 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005633 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005634 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005635
5636 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5637 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5638 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5639 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5640
5641 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5642 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5643 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5644 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5645
5646 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5647 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5648 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5649 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5650 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5651 chroot is performed.
5652
5653 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5654 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5655 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5656 considered.
5657
5658 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5659 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5660 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5661 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5662 considered as a raw string.
5663
5664 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5665 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5666 "content-type".
5667
5668 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5669 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5670 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5671 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5672 evaluated as a log-format string.
5673
5674 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5675 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5676 argument to "content-type".
5677
5678 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5679 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5680 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5681 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5682
5683 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5684 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5685 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5686 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5687 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5688 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5689 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5690 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5691
5692 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5693 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5694 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5695
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005696 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5697 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5698 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5699 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5700 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5701
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005702 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5703 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5704
5705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005706http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005707 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5708
5709 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5710 no | yes | yes | yes
5711
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005712 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5713 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5714 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5715 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5716 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005717
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005718 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5719 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005720
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005721 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005722
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005723 Example:
5724 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5725 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5726 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005727
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005728 http-request allow if nagios
5729 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5730 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5731 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005732
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005733 Example:
5734 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5735 acl add path /addacl
5736 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005737
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005738 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005739
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005740 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5741 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005742
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005743 Example:
5744 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5745 acl setmap path /setmap
5746 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005748 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005749
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005750 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5751 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005752
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005753 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5754 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005755
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005756http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005757
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005758 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5759 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5760 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5761 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5762 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5763 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5764 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5765 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005766
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005767http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005769 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5770 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5771 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5772 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5773 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5774 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5775 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5776 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005777
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005778http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005779
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005780 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5781 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005782
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005783
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005784http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005785
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005786 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5787 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5788 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5789 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5790 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005791
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005792 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5793 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5794 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5795 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5796 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5797 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5798 instead.
5799
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005800 Example:
5801 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5802 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005803
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005804http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005805
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005806 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005807
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005808http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5809 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005810
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005811 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5812 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5813 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5814 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5815 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5816 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5817 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5818 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5819 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005820
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005821 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5822 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5823 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005824 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5825
5826 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5827 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5828 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5829 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005830
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005831http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005832
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005833 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5834 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5835 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5836 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5837 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5838 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005839
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005840http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005841
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005842 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5843 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5844 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5845 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5846 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005847
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005848http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005849
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005850 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5851 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5852 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5853 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5854 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5855 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005856
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005857http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5858http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5859 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5860 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5861 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5862 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005863
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005864 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5865 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5866 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005867 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005868 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5869 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5870 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005871 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005872 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005873
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005874http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5875 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5876 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5877 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5878
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005879http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5880
5881 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5882 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5883 pointed by <resolvers>.
5884 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5885 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5886 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5887 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5888 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5889 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5890 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5891 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5892 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5893 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5894 to 0.0.0.0.
5895
5896 Example:
5897 resolvers mydns
5898 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5899 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5900 timeout retry 1s
5901 hold valid 10s
5902 hold nx 3s
5903 hold other 3s
5904 hold obsolete 0s
5905 accepted_payload_size 8192
5906
5907 frontend fe
5908 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5909 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5910 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5911
5912 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5913 # which mean DNS resolution error
5914 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5915
5916 default_backend be
5917
5918 backend b_503
5919 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5920 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5921 # 503 error page to end users
5922
5923 backend be
5924 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5925 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5926 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5927 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5928 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5929
5930 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5931 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5932
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005933http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5934
5935 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5936 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5937 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5938 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005939 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5940 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005941
5942 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5943
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005944http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005945
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005946 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5947 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5948 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5949 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5950 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005951
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005952http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005953
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005954 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5955 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5956 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5957 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005958
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005959http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5960 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005961
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005962 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005963 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5964 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5965 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5966 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5967 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005968
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005969 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5970 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5971 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5972 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5973 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005974
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005975 Example:
5976 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5977
5978 # applied to:
5979 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5980
5981 # outputs:
5982 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5983
5984 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005985
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005986 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5987
5988 # applied to:
5989 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005990
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005991 # outputs:
5992 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005993
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005994http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5995 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5996
5997 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5998 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005999 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6000 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6001 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006002
6003 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6004 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6005 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6006
6007 Example:
6008 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6009 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6010
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006011 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6012 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6013 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6014 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6015
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006016http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6017 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6018
6019 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6020 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6021 query-string are replaced.
6022
6023 Example:
6024 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6025 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6026
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006027http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6028 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6029
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006030 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6031 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6032 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6033 against.
6034
6035 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6036 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6037 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006038
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006039 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6040 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6041 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6042 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6043 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6044 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6045 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6046 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6047 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006048 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6049 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006050
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006051 Example:
6052 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6053 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006054
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006055 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6056 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006057
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006058http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6059 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006060
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006061 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6062 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6063 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6064 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006065
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006066 Example:
6067 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006068
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006069 # applied to:
6070 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006071
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006072 # outputs:
6073 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006074
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006075http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6076 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6077 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006078 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006079 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6080
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006081 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006082 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6083 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006084 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006085 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006086 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006087 are followed to create the response :
6088
6089 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6090 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6091 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6092 ignored.
6093
6094 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6095 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006096 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006097 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6098 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006099
6100 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6101 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6102 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006103 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6104 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006105
6106 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6107 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6108 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006109 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006110 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006111 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006112
6113 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6114 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6115 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6116 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6117 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6118 as a raw content.
6119
6120 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6121 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6122 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6123 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6124 considered as a raw string.
6125
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006126 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006127 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6128 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6129 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6130
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006131 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6132 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006133 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006134
6135 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6136
6137 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006138 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006139 if { path /ping }
6140
6141 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6142 if { path /favicon.ico }
6143
6144 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6145 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6146 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6147
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006148http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6149http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006150
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006151 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6152 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6153 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006154
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006155http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6156 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006157
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006158 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6159 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6160 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6161 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006162
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006163http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006164
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006165 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6166 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6167 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6168 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6169 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006170
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006171 Arguments:
6172 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6173 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006174
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006175 Example:
6176 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6177 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006179 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6180 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006181
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006182http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006183
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006184 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6185 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6186 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006187
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006188 Arguments:
6189 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6190 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006191
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006192 Example:
6193 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6194 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006195
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006196 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6197 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6198 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006199
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006200http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006201
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006202 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6203 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6204 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6205 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6206 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006207
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006208 Example:
6209 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6210 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6211 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6212 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6213 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6214 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6215 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6216 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6217 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006218
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006219http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006220
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006221 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6222 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6223 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6224 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6225 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006226
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006227http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6228 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006229
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006230 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6231 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6232 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6233 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6234 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6235 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6236 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6237 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6238 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006239
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006240http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006242 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6243 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6244 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6245 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6246 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6247 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6248 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006249
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006250http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006252 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6253 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6254 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006255
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006256http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006257
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006258 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6259 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6260 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6261 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6262 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6263 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6264 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6265 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006266
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006267http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006268
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006269 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6270 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6271 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6272 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6273 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6274 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006275
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006276 Example :
6277 # prepend the host name before the path
6278 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006279
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006280http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6281
6282 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6283 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6284 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6285
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006286http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006288 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6289 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6290 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6291 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6292 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006293
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006294http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006295
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006296 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6297 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6298 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6299 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6300 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6301 values have higher priority.
6302 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6303 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6304 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6305 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6306 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006307
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006308http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006309
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006310 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6311 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6312 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6313 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6314 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6315 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6316 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006317
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006318 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006319
6320 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006321 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6322 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006324http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6325 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6326 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6327 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006328 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6329 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006330
6331 Arguments :
6332 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6333 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006334
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006335 See also "option forwardfor".
6336
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006337 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006338 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6339 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6340
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006341 # After the masking this will track connections
6342 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6343 http-request track-sc0 src
6344
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006345 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6346 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6347
6348http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6349
6350 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6351 expression.
6352
6353 Arguments:
6354 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6355 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006356
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006357 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006358 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6359 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6360
6361 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6362 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6363 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6364
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006365http-request set-timeout server|tunnel { <timeout> | <expr> }
6366 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6367
6368 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6369 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6370 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6371 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6372 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6373
6374 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6375 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6376 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6377 results.
6378
6379 Example:
6380 http-request set-timeout server 5s
6381 http-request set-timeout hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
6382
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006383http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6384
6385 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6386 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6387 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6388 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6389 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6390 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6391 information from the request.
6392
6393 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6394
6395http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6396
6397 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6398 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6399 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6400 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6401 path and the query string.
6402 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6403
6404http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6405
6406 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6407 inline.
6408
6409 Arguments:
6410 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6411 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6412 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6413 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6414 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6415 (request and response)
6416 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6417 processing
6418 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6419 processing
6420 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6421 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6422 and '_'.
6423
6424 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6425 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006426
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006427 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006428 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006429
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006430http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6431 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006432
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006433 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6434 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6435 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6436 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6437 agent name must be used.
6438
6439 Arguments:
6440 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6441
6442 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6443 configuration.
6444
6445http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6446
6447 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6448 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6449 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6450 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6451 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6452 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6453 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6454 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6455 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6456 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6457 action.
6458 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6459 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6460 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6461 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6462 you fully understand how it works.
6463
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006464http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6465
6466 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6467 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6468 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6469 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6470 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006471 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006472 processing.
6473
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006474 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006475 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6476 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6477 rules evaluation.
6478
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006479http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6480http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6481 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6482 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6483 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6484 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006485
6486 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6487 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6488 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006489 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6490 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6491 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6492 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6493 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6494 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6495 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6496 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6497 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6498 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006499 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006500 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6501 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6502 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6503 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6504 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006505
6506http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6507http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6508http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6509
6510 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6511 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6512 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6513 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006514 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006515 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6516 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6517 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6518 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6519 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6520 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6521 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6522
6523 Arguments :
6524 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6525 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6526 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6527 select which table entry to update the counters.
6528
6529 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6530 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6531 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6532 that table until the session ends.
6533
6534 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6535 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6536 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6537 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6538 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6539 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6540 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6541 useful information.
6542
6543 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6544 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6545 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6546 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6547 checks that make use of it.
6548
6549http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6550
6551 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006552
6553 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006554 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006555
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006556http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6557
6558 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6559 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6560 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6561 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6562 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6563 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6564
6565 Arguments :
6566 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6567
6568 Example:
6569 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6570
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006571http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006572
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006573 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6574 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6575 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006576
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006577
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006578http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006579 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6580
6581 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6582 no | yes | yes | yes
6583
6584 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6585 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6586 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6587 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6588 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6589 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6590
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006591 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6592 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006593
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006594 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006595
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006596 Example:
6597 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006598
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006599 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006600
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006601 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6602 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006603
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006604 Example:
6605 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006606
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006607 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006608
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006609 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6610 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006611
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006612 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6613 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006614
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006615http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006616
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006617 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6618 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6619 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6620 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6621 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6622 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6623 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6624 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006625
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006626http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006627
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006628 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6629 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6630 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6631 example, or to pass some internal information.
6632 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6633 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6634 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006635
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006636http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006637
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006638 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6639 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006640
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006641http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006642
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006643 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006644
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006645http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006646
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006647 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6648 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6649 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6650 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6651 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6652 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6653 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006654
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006655 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6656 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6657 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6658 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6659 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006660
6661 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6662 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6663 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6664 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006665
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006666http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006667
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006668 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6669 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6670 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6671 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6672 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6673 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006674
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006675http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006676
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006677 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6678 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6679 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6680 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6681 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006682
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006683http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006684
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006685 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6686 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6687 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6688 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6689 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6690 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006691
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006692http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6693http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6694 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6695 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6696 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6697 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006698
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006699 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6700 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6701 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006702 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006703 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6704 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6705 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006706 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006707 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006708
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006709http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006710
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006711 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6712 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6713 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6714 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6715 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6716 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006717
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006718http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6719 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006720
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006721 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6722 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006723
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006724 Example:
6725 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006726
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006727 # applied to:
6728 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006729
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006730 # outputs:
6731 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006732
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006733 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006734
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006735http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6736 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006737
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006738 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006739 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006740
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006741 Example:
6742 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006743
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006744 # applied to:
6745 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006746
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006747 # outputs:
6748 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006749
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006750http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6751 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6752 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006753 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006754 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6755
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006756 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006757 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6758 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006759 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006760 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006761 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006762 are followed to create the response :
6763
6764 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6765 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6766 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6767 ignored.
6768
6769 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6770 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006771 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006772 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6773 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006774
6775 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6776 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6777 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006778 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6779 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006780
6781 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6782 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6783 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006784 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006785 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006786 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006787
6788 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6789 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6790 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6791 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6792 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6793 as a raw content.
6794
6795 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6796 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6797 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6798 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6799 considered as a raw string.
6800
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006801 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6802 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6803 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6804 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6805
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006806 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6807 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006808 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006809
6810 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6811
6812 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006813 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006814 if { status eq 404 }
6815
6816 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6817 string "This is the end !" \
6818 if { status eq 500 }
6819
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006820http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6821http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006822
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006823 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6824 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6825 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006826
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006827http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6828 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006829
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006830 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6831 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6832 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6833 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006834
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006835http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006836
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006837 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6838 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6839 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6840 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6841 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006842
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006843 Arguments:
6844 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006845
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006846 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6847 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006848
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006849http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006850
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006851 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6852 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6853 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006854
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006855http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6856
6857 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6858 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6859 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6860 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6861 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6862
6863http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6864
6865 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6866 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6867 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6868 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6869 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6870 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6871 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6872 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6873 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6874
6875http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6876
6877 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6878 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6879 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6880 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6881 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6882 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6883 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6884
6885http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6886
6887 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6888 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6889 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6890 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6891 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6892 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6893 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6894 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6895
6896http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6897 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6898
6899 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6900 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6901 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6902 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006903
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006904 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006905 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6906 http-response set-status 431
6907 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6908 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006909
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006910http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006911
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006912 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6913 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6914 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6915 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6916 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6917 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6918 based on some information from the request.
6919
6920 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6921
6922http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6923
6924 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6925 inline.
6926
6927 Arguments:
6928 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6929 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6930 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6931 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6932 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6933 (request and response)
6934 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6935 processing
6936 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6937 processing
6938 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6939 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6940 and '_'.
6941
6942 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6943 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006944
6945 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006946 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006947
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006948http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006949
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006950 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6951 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6952 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6953 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6954 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6955 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6956 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6957 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6958 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6959 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6960 action.
6961 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6962 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6963 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6964 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6965 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006966
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006967http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6968
6969 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6970 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6971 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6972 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6973 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006974 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006975 processing.
6976
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006977 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006978 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006979 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006980 rules evaluation.
6981
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006982http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6983http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6984http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006985
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006986 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6987 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6988 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6989 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6990 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6991 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6992
6993http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6994
6995 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6996 about <var-name>.
6997
6998 Example:
6999 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7000
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007001
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007002http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7003 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7004
7005 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7006 yes | no | yes | yes
7007
7008 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007009 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7010 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7011 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007012
7013 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7014
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007015 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7016 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7017 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7018 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7019 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7020 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7021 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
7022 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
7023 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7024 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007025
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007026 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7027 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7028 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7029 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7030 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7031 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7032 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007033 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7034 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7035 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7036 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7037 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7038 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007039
7040 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7041 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7042 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7043 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7044 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7045 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7046 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7047 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007048 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007049 downsides of rare connection failures.
7050
7051 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7052 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7053 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7054 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7055 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7056 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007057 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007058 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7059 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7060 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7061 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7062 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7063
7064 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007065 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7066 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7067 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7068 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007069
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007070 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7071 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007072
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007073 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007074
7075 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7076 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7077 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7078
7079 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7080
7081
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007082http-send-name-header [<header>]
7083 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007084 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7085 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007086 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007087 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7088
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007089 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7090 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7091 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7092 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7093 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7094 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7095 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7096 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7097 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7098 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7099 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7100 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7101 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7102 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7103 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7104 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007105
7106 See also : "server"
7107
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007108id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007109 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7111 no | yes | yes | yes
7112 Arguments : none
7113
7114 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7115 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7116 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007117
7118
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007119ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7120 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7121 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007122 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007123
7124 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7125 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7126 and running).
7127
7128 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7129 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7130 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007131 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007132 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7133
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007134 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7135 "unless" condition is met.
7136
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007137 Example:
7138 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7139 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7140 ignore-persist if url_static
7141
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007142 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7143
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007144load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7145 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7146 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7147 yes | no | yes | yes
7148
7149 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7150 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7151 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007152 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007153 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7154 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7155 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7156 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7157
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007158 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007159 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007160 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007161
7162 Arguments:
7163 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7164 named "server-state-file".
7165
7166 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7167 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7168 name is used as a file name.
7169
7170 none don't load any stat for this backend
7171
7172 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007173 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7174 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7175 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007176 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007177 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007178
7179 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7180 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7181
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007182 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007183
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007184 global
7185 stats socket /tmp/socket
7186 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007187
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007188 defaults
7189 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007190
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007191 backend bk
7192 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7193 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007194
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007195
7196 Then one can run :
7197
7198 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7199
7200 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7201
7202 1
7203 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7204 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7205 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7206
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007207 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007208
7209 global
7210 stats socket /tmp/socket
7211 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7212
7213 defaults
7214 load-server-state-from-file local
7215
7216 backend bk
7217 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7218 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7219
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007220
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007221 Then one can run :
7222
7223 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7224
7225 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7226
7227 1
7228 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7229 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7230 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7231
7232 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7233 "show servers state"
7234
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007235
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007236log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007237log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007238 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007239no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007240 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7242 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007243
7244 Prefix :
7245 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7246 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7247 prefix does not allow arguments.
7248
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007249 Arguments :
7250 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7251 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7252 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7253 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7254 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7255 parameter.
7256
7257 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7258 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7259
7260 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7261 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7262 standard syslog port).
7263
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007264 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7265 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7266 standard syslog port).
7267
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007268 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7269 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7270 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007271 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007272
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007273 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7274 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7275 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7276 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7277 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7278 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7279 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7280 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7281 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7282 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7283 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7284 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7285 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7286 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7287 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7288 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007289 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7290 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007291
7292 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7293 and "fd@2", see above.
7294
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007295 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7296 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7297 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7298 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7299 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7300 having the logs instantly available.
7301
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007302 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7303 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007304
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007305 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7306 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7307 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7308 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7309 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7310 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7311 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7312 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7313 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7314 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007315 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007316
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007317 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7318 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7319 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7320 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7321 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7322
7323 <sample_size>
7324 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7325 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7326 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7327 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7328 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7329
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007330 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7331 one of the following :
7332
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007333 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7334 field is stripped. This is the default.
7335 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7336 rfc3164.
7337
7338 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007339 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7340
7341 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7342 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7343
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007344 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7345 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7346 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7347 designed to be used with a local log server.
7348
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007349 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7350 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7351 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7352 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7353 systemd logger consumes.
7354
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007355 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7356 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7357 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7358 used with a local log server.
7359
7360 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7361 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7362 designed to be used with a local log server.
7363
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007364 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7365 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7366 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7367 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7368
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007369 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7370
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007371 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7372 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7373 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7374
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007375 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7376 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7377 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7378 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007379
7380 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7381 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7382 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007383 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7384 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7385 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7386 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7387 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007388
7389 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7390
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007391 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7392 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7393 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007394
7395 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7396 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7397 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7398 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7399
7400 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7401 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007402
7403 Example :
7404 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007405 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7406 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7407 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007408 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7409 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007410 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007411
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007412
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007413log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007414 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7415 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7416 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007417
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007418 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7419 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7420 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7421 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7422 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007423
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007424 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7425 "option httplog" directives.
7426
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007427log-format-sd <string>
7428 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7429 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7430 yes | yes | yes | no
7431
7432 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7433 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7434 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7435 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7436 which covers the log format string in depth.
7437
7438 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7439 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7440
7441 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7442 log format to "rfc5424".
7443
7444 Example :
7445 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7446
7447
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007448log-tag <string>
7449 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7450 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7451 yes | yes | yes | yes
7452
7453 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7454 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7455 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7456 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7457 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7458 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7459 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7460 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7461 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007462
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007463max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7464 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7465 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7466 yes | no | yes | yes
7467
7468 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7469 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7470 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7471 servers.
7472
7473 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7474 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7475 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7476 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7477 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007478 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007479 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7480 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7481 picking a different server.
7482
7483 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7484 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7485 even if they have to be queued.
7486
7487 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7488 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7489
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007490max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7491 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7492 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7493 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007494
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007495maxconn <conns>
7496 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7498 yes | yes | yes | no
7499 Arguments :
7500 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7501 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7502 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7503 closes.
7504
7505 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7506 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7507 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7508 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007509 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7510 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7511 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7512 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007513
7514 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7515 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7516 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7517
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007518 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7519 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007520
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007521 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7522
7523
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007524mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007525 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7527 yes | yes | yes | yes
7528 Arguments :
7529 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7530 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7531 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7532 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7533
7534 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7535 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7536 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7537 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7538 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7539
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007540 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7541 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7542 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007543
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007544 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007545 defaults http_instances
7546 mode http
7547
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007548
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007549monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007550 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7552 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007553 Arguments :
7554 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7555 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007556 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007557 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7558 backend and its backup.
7559
7560 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7561 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7562 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7563 servers in a list of backends.
7564
7565 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7566 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7567 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7568 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7569 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7570 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7571 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007572 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7573 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007574
7575 Example:
7576 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007577 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007578 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7579 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7580 monitor-uri /site_alive
7581 monitor fail if site_dead
7582
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007583 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007584
7585
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007586monitor-uri <uri>
7587 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7589 yes | yes | yes | no
7590 Arguments :
7591 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7592 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7593
7594 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7595 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7596 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7597 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7598 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7599 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7600 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7601 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7602
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007603 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007604 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7605 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7606 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7607 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7608 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7609 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007610
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007611 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7612 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7613 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7614 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7615
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007616 Example :
7617 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7618 frontend www
7619 mode http
7620 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7621
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007622 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007623
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007624
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007625option abortonclose
7626no option abortonclose
7627 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7629 yes | no | yes | yes
7630 Arguments : none
7631
7632 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7633 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7634 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7635 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007636 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007637 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7638 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7639 encountered while delivering the response.
7640
7641 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7642 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7643 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7644 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7645 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7646 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007647 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007648 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007649 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007650 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7651 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7652 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7653
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007654 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7655 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007656 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7657 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7658 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7659 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7660 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7661 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007662 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007663
7664 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7665 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7666
7667 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7668
7669
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007670option accept-invalid-http-request
7671no option accept-invalid-http-request
7672 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7674 yes | yes | yes | no
7675 Arguments : none
7676
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007677 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007678 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007679 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007680 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7681 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7682 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7683 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7684 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007685 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7686 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7687 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7688 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007689 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007690 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007691 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7692 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7693 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007694
7695 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7696 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7697 been confirmed.
7698
7699 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7700 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007701 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7702 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007703 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7704
7705 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7706 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7707
7708 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7709 stats socket.
7710
7711
7712option accept-invalid-http-response
7713no option accept-invalid-http-response
7714 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7716 yes | no | yes | yes
7717 Arguments : none
7718
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007719 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007720 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007721 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007722 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7723 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7724 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7725 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7726 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007727 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7728 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7729 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007730
7731 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7732 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7733 been confirmed.
7734
7735 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7736 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7737 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7738 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7739
7740 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7741 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7742
7743 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7744 stats socket.
7745
7746
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007747option allbackups
7748no option allbackups
7749 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7751 yes | no | yes | yes
7752 Arguments : none
7753
7754 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7755 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7756 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7757 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7758 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7759 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7760 order between the backup servers anymore.
7761
7762 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7763 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7764
7765 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7766 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7767
7768
7769option checkcache
7770no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007771 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7773 yes | no | yes | yes
7774 Arguments : none
7775
7776 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7777 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007778 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007779 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7780 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007781 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007782
7783 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007784 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007785 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007786 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7787 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007788 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007789 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007790 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7791 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007792 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007793 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7794 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007795 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007796 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7797 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7798 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7799 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7800 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7801 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7802 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7803 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7804 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7805
7806 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007807 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7808 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7809 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7810 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007811
7812 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7813 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007814 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007815 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007816
7817 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7818 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7819
7820
7821option clitcpka
7822no option clitcpka
7823 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7825 yes | yes | yes | no
7826 Arguments : none
7827
7828 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7829 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007830 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007831 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7832
7833 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7834 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7835 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7836 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7837
7838 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7839 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7840 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7841 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7842 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7843
7844 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7845
7846 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7847 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7848 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7849
7850 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7851 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7852
7853 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7854
7855
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007856option contstats
7857 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7859 yes | yes | yes | no
7860 Arguments : none
7861
7862 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7863 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7864 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7865 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007866 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7867 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7868 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7869 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7870 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007871
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007872option disable-h2-upgrade
7873no option disable-h2-upgrade
7874 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7875 connection.
7876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7877 yes | yes | yes | no
7878 Arguments : none
7879
7880 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7881 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7882 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7883 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7884 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7885 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7886 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7887 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7888
7889 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7890 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007891
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007892option dontlog-normal
7893no option dontlog-normal
7894 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7896 yes | yes | yes | no
7897 Arguments : none
7898
7899 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7900 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7901 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7902 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7903 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7904 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7905 logged.
7906
7907 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7908 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7909 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007911 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007912 logging.
7913
7914
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007915option dontlognull
7916no option dontlognull
7917 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7919 yes | yes | yes | no
7920 Arguments : none
7921
7922 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7923 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7924 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7925 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7926 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7927 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007928 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7929 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7930 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007931
7932 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007933 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007934 would not be logged.
7935
7936 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7937 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7938
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007939 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007940 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007941
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007942
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007943option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007944 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7946 yes | yes | yes | yes
7947 Arguments :
7948 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7949 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007950 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007951 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007952
7953 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7954 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7955 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7956 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7957 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7958 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7959 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007960 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7961 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7962 possible that the client has already brought one.
7963
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007964 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007965 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007966 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007967 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007968 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007969 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007970
7971 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7972 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7973 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7974 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7975 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7976 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01007977 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007978
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007979 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7980 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7981 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7982 are under the control of the end-user.
7983
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007984 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007985 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7986 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007987 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7988 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7989 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007990
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007991 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007992 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7993 frontend www
7994 mode http
7995 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7996
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007997 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7998 backend www
7999 mode http
8000 option forwardfor header X-Client
8001
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008002 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008003 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008004
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008005
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008006option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8007no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8008 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8010 yes | yes | yes | no
8011 Arguments : none
8012
8013 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8014 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8015 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8016 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8017 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8018 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8019 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8020
8021 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8022 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8023 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8024 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8025 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8026 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8027 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8028 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8029 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8030 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8031
8032 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8033
8034 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8035 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8036
8037 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8038 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8039
8040
8041option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8042no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8043 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8045 yes | no | yes | yes
8046 Arguments : none
8047
8048 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8049 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8050 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8051 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8052 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8053 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8054 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8055
8056 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8057 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8058 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8059 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8060 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8061 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8062 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8063 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8064 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8065 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8066
8067 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8068
8069 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8070 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8071
8072 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8073 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8074
8075
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008076option http-buffer-request
8077no option http-buffer-request
8078 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8080 yes | yes | yes | yes
8081 Arguments : none
8082
8083 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8084 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8085 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8086 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8087 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8088 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008089 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8090 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8091 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8092 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008093
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01008094 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008095
8096
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008097option http-ignore-probes
8098no option http-ignore-probes
8099 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8101 yes | yes | yes | no
8102 Arguments : none
8103
8104 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8105 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8106 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8107 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8108 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8109 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8110 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8111 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8112 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008113 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8114 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008115 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8116
8117 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8118 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8119 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8120 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8121 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8122 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8123 are often the only way to detect them.
8124
8125 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8126 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8127
8128 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8129
8130
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008131option http-keep-alive
8132no option http-keep-alive
8133 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8135 yes | yes | yes | yes
8136 Arguments : none
8137
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008138 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8139 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008140 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8141 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008142 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8143 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8144 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008145
8146 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8147 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008148 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8149 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8150 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8151 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8152 situations where this option may be useful :
8153
8154 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008155 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008156
8157 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8158 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8159
8160 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8161 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8162 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8163 request.
8164
8165 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8166 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008167 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8168 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8169 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008170
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008171 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8172 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8173 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8174 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8175 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8176 not set.
8177
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008178 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8179 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8180 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008181
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008182 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008183 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008184 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008185
8186
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008187option http-no-delay
8188no option http-no-delay
8189 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8191 yes | yes | yes | yes
8192 Arguments : none
8193
8194 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8195 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8196 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8197 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8198 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8199 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8200 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8201 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8202 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8203 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8204 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8205 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8206 affected.
8207
8208 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8209 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8210 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8211 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8212 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8213 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8214 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8215 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8216 latency environments.
8217
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008218 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8219
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008220
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008221option http-pretend-keepalive
8222no option http-pretend-keepalive
8223 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008225 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008226 Arguments : none
8227
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008228 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008229 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8230 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8231 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8232 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8233 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8234 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8235 consider the response complete.
8236
8237 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8238 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8239 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8240 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008241 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008242 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8243
8244 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8245 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8246 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8247 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8248 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8249 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8250 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8251
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008252 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8253 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8254 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8255 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8256 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8257 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008258
8259 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8260 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8261
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008262 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008263 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008264
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008265
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008266option http-server-close
8267no option http-server-close
8268 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8270 yes | yes | yes | yes
8271 Arguments : none
8272
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008273 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8274 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8275 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8276 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008277 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8278 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8279 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8280 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8281 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8282 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8283 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8284 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8285 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8286 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8287 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008288
8289 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8290 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8291 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8292 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008293 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8294 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008295
8296 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8297 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008298 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8299 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8300 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008301
8302 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8303 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8304
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008305 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8306 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008307
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008308option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008309no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008310 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8312 yes | yes | yes | no
8313 Arguments : none
8314
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008315 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008316 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8317 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8318 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8319 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8320 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8321 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8322
8323 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8324 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008325 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8326 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8327 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008328
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008329 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8330 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8331 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8332 front of an existing proxy.
8333
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008334 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8335
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008336 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008337
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008338option httpchk
8339option httpchk <uri>
8340option httpchk <method> <uri>
8341option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008342 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8344 yes | no | yes | yes
8345 Arguments :
8346 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8347 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8348 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8349 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8350 ones.
8351
8352 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8353 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8354 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8355
8356 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8357 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8358 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008359 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008360
8361 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8362 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8363 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8364 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8365 the lack of any response.
8366
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008367 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8368 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8369 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8370 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8371
8372 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8373 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8374 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008375
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008376 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8377 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008378 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008379 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008380 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008381
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008382 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8383 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8384 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8385 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8386
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008387 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008388 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8389 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8390 backend https_relay
8391 mode tcp
8392 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8393 http-check send hdr Host www
8394 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008395
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008396 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8397 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8398 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008399
8400
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008401option httpclose
8402no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008403 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8405 yes | yes | yes | yes
8406 Arguments : none
8407
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008408 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8409 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8410 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8411 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008412 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008413
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008414 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8415 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008416 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008417 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8418 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008419
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008420 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8421 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8422 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008423
8424 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8425 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008426 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8427 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8428 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008429
8430 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8431 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8432
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008433 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008434
8435
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008436option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008437 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008439 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008440 Arguments :
8441 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8442 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8443 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008444 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008445 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008446
8447 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8448 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8449 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8450 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8451 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8452 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8453 ports.
8454
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008455 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8456 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008457
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008458 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8459
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008460 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008461
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008462
8463option http_proxy
8464no option http_proxy
8465 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8467 yes | yes | yes | yes
8468 Arguments : none
8469
8470 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8471 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8472 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8473 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8474 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8475
8476 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8477 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008478 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8479 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008480
8481 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8482 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8483
8484 Example :
8485 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8486 backend direct_forward
8487 option httpclose
8488 option http_proxy
8489
8490 See also : "option httpclose"
8491
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008492
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008493option independent-streams
8494no option independent-streams
8495 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8497 yes | yes | yes | yes
8498 Arguments : none
8499
8500 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8501 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8502 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8503 receive data or not.
8504
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008505 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008506 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8507 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8508 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8509 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8510 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8511 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8512 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8513 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8514 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8515 socket buffers.
8516
8517 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8518 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8519 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8520 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8521 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8522
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008523 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008524
8525
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008526option ldap-check
8527 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8529 yes | no | yes | yes
8530 Arguments : none
8531
8532 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8533 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8534 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8535 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8536
8537 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8538 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8539
8540 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8541 configure it.
8542
8543 Example :
8544 option ldap-check
8545
8546 See also : "option httpchk"
8547
8548
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008549option external-check
8550 Use external processes for server health checks
8551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8552 yes | no | yes | yes
8553
8554 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8555 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8556 command".
8557
8558 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8559
8560 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8561
8562
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008563option log-health-checks
8564no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008565 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8567 yes | no | yes | yes
8568 Arguments : none
8569
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008570 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8571 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8572 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008573
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008574 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8575 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8576 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8577 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8578 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8579
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008580 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008581 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008582
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008583 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8584 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8585 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008586
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008587
8588option log-separate-errors
8589no option log-separate-errors
8590 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8592 yes | yes | yes | no
8593 Arguments : none
8594
8595 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8596 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8597 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8598 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8599 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8600 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8601 provides very important information.
8602
8603 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8604 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8605 error logs.
8606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008607 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008608 logging.
8609
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008610
8611option logasap
8612no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008613 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8615 yes | yes | yes | no
8616 Arguments : none
8617
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008618 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8619 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8620 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8621 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8622
8623 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8624 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8625 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8626 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8627 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008628 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008629 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8630 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8631 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8632 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008633 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008634
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008635 Examples :
8636 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8637 mode http
8638 option httplog
8639 option logasap
8640 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8641
8642 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8643 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8644 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8645 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008647 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008648 logging.
8649
8650
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008651option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008652 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8654 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008655 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008656 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8657 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008658 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8659 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008660
8661 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8662 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008663 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008664 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8665 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8666 in the MySQL table, like this :
8667
8668 USE mysql;
8669 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8670 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8671
8672 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008673 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008674 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8675 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8676 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8677 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8678 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8679 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8680 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8681
8682 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8683 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008684
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008685 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008686
8687 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8688 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8689 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8690 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008691 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8692 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008693
8694 See also: "option httpchk"
8695
8696
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008697option nolinger
8698no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008699 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008700 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8701 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008702 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008703
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008704 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008705 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8706 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8707 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8708 connections.
8709
8710 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8711 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008712 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8713 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8714 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8715 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8716 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8717 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8718 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8719 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8720 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8721 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8722 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8723 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8724 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008725
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008726 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8727 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8728 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8729 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8730 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008731
8732 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8733 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008734 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05008735 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008736 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008737
8738 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8739 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8740
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008741 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8742 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008743
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008744option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8745 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8747 yes | yes | yes | yes
8748 Arguments :
8749 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8750 matching <network>
8751 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8752 header name.
8753
8754 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8755 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8756 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8757 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8758 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8759 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8760 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8761 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8762 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8763 possible that the client has already brought one.
8764
8765 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8766 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8767 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8768 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8769 header and requires different one.
8770
8771 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8772 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8773 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01008774 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
8775 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
8776 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
8777 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
8778 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008779
8780 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8781 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8782 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8783 both are defined.
8784
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008785 Examples :
8786 # Original Destination address
8787 frontend www
8788 mode http
8789 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8790
8791 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8792 backend www
8793 mode http
8794 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8795
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008796 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008797
8798
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008799option persist
8800no option persist
8801 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8802 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8803 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008804 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008805
8806 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8807 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8808 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8809 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8810 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8811 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8812 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8813 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8814 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8815 redirected to another valid server.
8816
8817 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8818 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8819
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008820 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008821
8822
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008823option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8824 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8826 yes | no | yes | yes
8827 Arguments :
8828 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8829 PostgreSQL server.
8830
8831 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8832 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8833 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8834 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8835
8836 See also: "option httpchk"
8837
8838
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008839option prefer-last-server
8840no option prefer-last-server
8841 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8842 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8843 yes | no | yes | yes
8844 Arguments : none
8845
8846 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8847 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8848 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8849 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8850 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8851 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8852 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8853 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8854 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008855 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8856 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008857 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8858 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8859 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008860 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8861 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8862 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008863
8864 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8865 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8866
8867 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8868
8869
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008870option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008871option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008872no option redispatch
8873 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8874 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8875 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008876 Arguments :
8877 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8878 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8879 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008880 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008881 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008882 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008883 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8884 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8885 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008887
8888 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8889 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8890 be able to access the service anymore.
8891
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008892 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8893 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008894
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008895 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8896 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8897 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8898 following order:
8899
8900 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8901
8902 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8903 list, or
8904
8905 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8906
8907 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8908 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8909
8910 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8911 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8912 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8913 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8914
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008915 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008916 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8917 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008918
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008919 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8920 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8921
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008922 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008923
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008924
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008925option redis-check
8926 Use redis health checks for server testing
8927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8928 yes | no | yes | yes
8929 Arguments : none
8930
8931 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8932 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8933 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8934 find the "+PONG" response message.
8935
8936 Example :
8937 option redis-check
8938
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008939 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008940
8941
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008942option smtpchk
8943option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8944 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8946 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008947 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008948 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008949 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008950 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8951
8952 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8953 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8954 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8955
8956 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8957 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8958 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8959 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8960 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8961 dead server.
8962
8963 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8964 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008965 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008966 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8967
8968 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8969 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8970 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8971 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008972 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008973
8974 Example :
8975 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8976
8977 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8978
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008980option socket-stats
8981no option socket-stats
8982
8983 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8985 yes | yes | yes | no
8986
8987 Arguments : none
8988
8989
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008990option splice-auto
8991no option splice-auto
8992 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8994 yes | yes | yes | yes
8995 Arguments : none
8996
8997 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8998 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008999 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009000 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009001 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009002 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9003 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9004 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9005 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9006
9007 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9008 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9009 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9010 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9011 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9012 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9013 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9014 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9015 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9016 keyword.
9017
9018 Example :
9019 option splice-auto
9020
9021 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9022 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9023
9024 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9025 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9026
9027
9028option splice-request
9029no option splice-request
9030 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9032 yes | yes | yes | yes
9033 Arguments : none
9034
9035 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009036 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009037 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9038 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9039 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9040 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9041
9042 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9043
9044 Example :
9045 option splice-request
9046
9047 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9048 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9049
9050 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9051 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9052
9053
9054option splice-response
9055no option splice-response
9056 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9058 yes | yes | yes | yes
9059 Arguments : none
9060
9061 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009062 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009063 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9064 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9065 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9066 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9067
9068 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9069
9070 Example :
9071 option splice-response
9072
9073 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9074 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9075
9076 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9077 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9078
9079
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009080option spop-check
9081 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9083 no | no | no | yes
9084 Arguments : none
9085
9086 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9087 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9088 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9089 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9090
9091 Example :
9092 option spop-check
9093
9094 See also : "option httpchk"
9095
9096
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009097option srvtcpka
9098no option srvtcpka
9099 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9101 yes | no | yes | yes
9102 Arguments : none
9103
9104 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9105 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009106 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009107 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9108
9109 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9110 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9111 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9112 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9113
9114 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9115 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9116 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9117 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9118 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9119
9120 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9121
9122 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9123 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9124 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9125
9126 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9127 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9128
9129 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9130
9131
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009132option ssl-hello-chk
9133 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9135 yes | no | yes | yes
9136 Arguments : none
9137
9138 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9139 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9140 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9141 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9142 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9143 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9144 hello message.
9145
9146 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9147 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9148 messages, which is appreciable.
9149
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009150 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9151 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9152 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009153
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009154 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9155
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009156
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009157option tcp-check
9158 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9159 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9160 yes | no | yes | yes
9161
9162 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9163 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9164
9165 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9166 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9167 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9168
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009169 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009170 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9171 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9172 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9173 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9174 only.
9175
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009176 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009177 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9178 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9179 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9180 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9181
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009182 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009183 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9184 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009185 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009186 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9187 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9188 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9189 the respective protocols.
9190 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009191 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009192
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009193 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009194
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009195 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9196 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9197 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9198 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009199
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009200 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9201 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9202 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009203
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009204
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009205 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009206 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009207 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009208 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009209
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009210 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009211 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009212 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009213
9214 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9215 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009216 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009217 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009218 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009219 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009220 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009221 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009222 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9223 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009224 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009225 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9226 tcp-check expect string +OK
9227
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009228 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009229 (send many headers before analyzing)
9230 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009231 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009232 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9233 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9234 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9235 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009236 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009237
9238
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009239 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009240
9241
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009242option tcp-smart-accept
9243no option tcp-smart-accept
9244 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9246 yes | yes | yes | no
9247 Arguments : none
9248
9249 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9250 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9251 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9252 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9253 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9254 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9255
9256 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9257 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9258 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9259 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9260
9261 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9262 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9263 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009264 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009265
9266 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9267 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9268 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9269
9270 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9271 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9272 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9273
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009274 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9275
9276
9277option tcp-smart-connect
9278no option tcp-smart-connect
9279 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9281 yes | no | yes | yes
9282 Arguments : none
9283
9284 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9285 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9286 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9287 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9288 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9289
9290 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9291 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9292 complex.
9293
9294 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9295 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9296 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9297
9298 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9299 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9300
9301 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9302
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009303
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009304option tcpka
9305 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9307 yes | yes | yes | yes
9308 Arguments : none
9309
9310 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9311 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009312 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009313 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9314
9315 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9316 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9317 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9318 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9319
9320 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9321 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9322 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9323 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9324 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9325
9326 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9327
9328 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9329 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9330 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9331 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9332 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9333 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9334 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9335 backends.
9336
9337 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9338
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009339
9340option tcplog
9341 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009343 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009344 Arguments : none
9345
9346 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9347 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9348 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9349 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9350 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9351 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9352 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9353 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9354
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009355 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9356
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009357 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009358
9359
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009360option transparent
9361no option transparent
9362 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009364 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009365 Arguments : none
9366
9367 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9368 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9369 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9370 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9371 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9372 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9373 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9374 appropriate server.
9375
9376 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9377 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9378
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009379 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009380 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009381
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009382
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009383external-check command <command>
9384 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9386 yes | no | yes | yes
9387
9388 Arguments :
9389 <command> is the external command to run
9390
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009391 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9392
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009393 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009394
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009395 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9396 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9397 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9398 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9399 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9400 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009401
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009402 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9403
9404 Environment variables :
9405 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9406 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9407
9408 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9409
9410 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9411
9412 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9413 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9414 for a UNIX socket).
9415
9416 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9417
9418 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9419
9420 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9421
9422 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9423
9424 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9425
9426 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9427 socket).
9428
9429 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9430 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9431
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009432 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9433
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009434 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9435 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9436 failed.
9437
9438 Example :
9439 external-check command /bin/true
9440
9441 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9442
9443
9444external-check path <path>
9445 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9447 yes | no | yes | yes
9448
9449 Arguments :
9450 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9451
9452 The default path is "".
9453
9454 Example :
9455 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9456
9457 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9458 "external-check command"
9459
9460
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009461persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009462persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009463 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9465 yes | no | yes | yes
9466 Arguments :
9467 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009468 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9469 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009470
9471 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9472 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009473 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009474 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9475 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9476 forwarded to this server.
9477
9478 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9479 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9480 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009481 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009482 a single "listen" section.
9483
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009484 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9485 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9486 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9487
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009488 Example :
9489 listen tse-farm
9490 bind :3389
9491 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9492 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9493 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9494 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9495 persist rdp-cookie
9496 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009497 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009498 balance rdp-cookie
9499 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9500 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9501
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009502 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9503 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009504
9505
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009506rate-limit sessions <rate>
9507 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9509 yes | yes | yes | no
9510 Arguments :
9511 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9512 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9513
9514 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9515 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9516 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9517 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9518 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9519 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9520
9521 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9522 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9523 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9524 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9525
9526 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9527 listen smtp
9528 mode tcp
9529 bind :25
9530 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009531 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009532
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009533 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9534 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9535 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009536
9537 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9538
9539
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009540redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9541redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9542redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009543 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9545 no | yes | yes | yes
9546
9547 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009548 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009549
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009550 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009551 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009552 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9553 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9554 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009555
9556 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9557 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9558 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9559 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9560 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009561 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9562 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9563 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9564 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009565
9566 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9567 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9568 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9569 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9570 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9571 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009572 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009573 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009574 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9575 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9576 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009577
9578 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009579 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9580 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9581 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009582 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009583 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9584 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9585 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9586 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009587
9588 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009589 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009590
9591 - "drop-query"
9592 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9593 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9594 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9595 with a location-type redirect.
9596
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009597 - "append-slash"
9598 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9599 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9600 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9601 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9602
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009603 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9604 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9605 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9606 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9607 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9608 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9609 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9610
9611 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9612 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9613 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9614 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9615 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9616 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9617 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009618
9619 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9620 acl clear dst_port 80
9621 acl secure dst_port 8080
9622 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009623 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009624 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009625 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9626
9627 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009628 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9629 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9630 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009631 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009632
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009633 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9634 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9635 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9636
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009637 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009638 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009639
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009640 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009641 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9642 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9643 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009644
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009645 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009646
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009647
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009648retries <value>
9649 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9650 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9651 yes | no | yes | yes
9652 Arguments :
9653 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9654 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9655 default value is 3.
9656
9657 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9658 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9659 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9660
9661 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009662 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9663 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009664
9665 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9666 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9667
9668 See also : "option redispatch"
9669
9670
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009671retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009672 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9673 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9674 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009675 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9676 yes | no | yes | yes
9677 Arguments :
9678 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9679 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9680 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9681 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9682
9683 none never retry
9684
9685 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9686 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9687
9688 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9689 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9690 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9691 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9692 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9693 processing the request.
9694
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009695 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9696 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9697 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9698 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9699 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9700 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9701 overflow attack for example).
9702
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009703 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9704 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9705 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9706 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9707 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9708 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9709 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9710 amplify denial of service attacks.
9711
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009712 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9713 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9714 considered to be safe to retry.
9715
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +01009716 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
9717 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
9718 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
9719 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
9720 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009721
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009722 all-retryable-errors
9723 retry request for any error that are considered
9724 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9725 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9726 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9727
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009728 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9729 not cumulative.
9730
9731 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9732 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9733 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9734 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9735
9736 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9737 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9738 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9739 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9740 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9741 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9742 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9743 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9744 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9745 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9746 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9747 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9748
9749 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9750 should not use this directive.
9751
9752 The default is "conn-failure".
9753
9754 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9755
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009756server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009757 Declare a server in a backend
9758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9759 no | no | yes | yes
9760 Arguments :
9761 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009762 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009763 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009764
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009765 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9766 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9767 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9768 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009769 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9770 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9771 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9772 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9773 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009774 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9775 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9776 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9777 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9778 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9779 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9780 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009781 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009782 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9783 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9784 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9785 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9786 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9787 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009788 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9789 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009790 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9791 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009792
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009793 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009794 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9795 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9796 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9797 adding this value to the client's port.
9798
9799 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9800 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009801 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009802
9803 Examples :
9804 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9805 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009806 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009807 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9808 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9809 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009810
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009811 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9812 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9813 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9814 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9815 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9816
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009817 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9818 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009819
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009820server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009821 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009822 this backend.
9823 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9824 no | no | yes | yes
9825
9826 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
9827 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
9828 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
9829 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
9830 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009831
9832 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9833 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9834
9835 global
9836 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9837
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009838 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009839 load-server-state-from-file
9840
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009841 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009842 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009843
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009844server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9845 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9846 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9848 no | no | yes | yes
9849
9850 Arguments:
9851 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9852
9853 <num | range>
9854 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9855 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9856 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9857 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9858
9859 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9860
9861 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9862
9863 <params*>
9864 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9865 keyword.
9866
9867 Examples:
9868 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9869 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9870 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9871
9872 # or
9873 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9874
9875 # would be equivalent to:
9876 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9877 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9878 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9879
9880
9881
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009882source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009883source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009884source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009885 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9887 yes | no | yes | yes
9888 Arguments :
9889 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9890 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009891
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009892 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009893 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9894 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9895 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9896 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9897 supported prefixes are :
9898 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9899 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9900 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009901 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009902 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9903 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009904
9905 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9906 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009907 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9908 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9909 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009910
9911 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9912 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9913 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9914 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9915 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9916 <addr>.
9917
9918 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9919 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9920 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9921 port.
9922
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009923 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9924 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9925 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9926 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009927 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009928 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9929 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9930 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9931 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9932 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9933 HTTP header.
9934
9935 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9936 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009937 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009938 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9939 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9940 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9941 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9942 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9943 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9944 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9945
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009946 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9947 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9948 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9949 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9950 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9951 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9952
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009953 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9954 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9955 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9956 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9957
9958 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9959 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9960 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9961 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9962 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9963 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9964
9965 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9966 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9967 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9968 there are two methods :
9969
9970 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9971 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9972 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9973 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9974 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9975 of the client ranges may be used.
9976
9977 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9978 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9979 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9980 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9981 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9982 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9983 same session.
9984
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009985 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9986 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9987 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009988 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009989
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009990 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9991
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009992 Examples :
9993 backend private
9994 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9995 source 192.168.1.200
9996
9997 backend transparent_ssl1
9998 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9999 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10000
10001 backend transparent_ssl2
10002 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10003 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10004 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10005
10006 backend transparent_ssl3
10007 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10008 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10009 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10010
10011 backend transparent_smtp
10012 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10013 # with Tproxy version 4.
10014 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10015
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010016 backend transparent_http
10017 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10018 # proxy.
10019 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10020
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010021 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010022 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10023
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010024
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010025srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10026 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10027 the connection on the server side.
10028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10029 yes | no | yes | yes
10030 Arguments :
10031 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10032
10033 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10034 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010035 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10036 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010037
10038 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10039
10040
10041srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10042 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10043 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10044 server side.
10045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10046 yes | no | yes | yes
10047 Arguments :
10048 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10049 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10050 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10051 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10052
10053 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10054 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010055 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10056 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010057
10058 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10059
10060
10061srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10062 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10064 yes | no | yes | yes
10065 Arguments :
10066 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10067 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10068 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10069 document.
10070
10071 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10072 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010073 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10074 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010075
10076 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10077
10078
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010079stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10080 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010082 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010083
10084 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10085 matched.
10086
10087 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10088 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10089
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010090 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10091 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010092 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010093
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010094 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10095 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10096 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10097 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010098
10099 Example :
10100 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10101 backend stats_localhost
10102 stats enable
10103 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10104
10105 Example :
10106 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10107 backend stats_auth
10108 stats enable
10109 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10110 stats admin if TRUE
10111
10112 Example :
10113 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10114 userlist stats-auth
10115 group admin users admin
10116 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10117 group readonly users haproxy
10118 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10119
10120 backend stats_auth
10121 stats enable
10122 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10123 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10124 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10125 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10126
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010127 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10128 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10129 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010130
10131
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010132stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10133 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010135 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010136 Arguments :
10137 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10138
10139 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10140
10141 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10142 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10143 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10144 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10145 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10146 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10147
10148 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10149 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10150 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010151 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010152
10153 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10154 report using "stats scope".
10155
10156 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10157 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10158 unobvious parameters.
10159
10160 Example :
10161 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10162 backend public_www
10163 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10164 stats enable
10165 stats hide-version
10166 stats scope .
10167 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010168 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010169 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10170 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10171
10172 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10173 backend private_monitoring
10174 stats enable
10175 stats uri /admin?stats
10176 stats refresh 5s
10177
10178 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10179
10180
10181stats enable
10182 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010184 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010185 Arguments : none
10186
10187 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10188 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10189 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10190 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10191 - stats auth : no authentication
10192 - stats scope : no restriction
10193
10194 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10195 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10196 unobvious parameters.
10197
10198 Example :
10199 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10200 backend public_www
10201 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10202 stats enable
10203 stats hide-version
10204 stats scope .
10205 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010206 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010207 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10208 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10209
10210 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10211 backend private_monitoring
10212 stats enable
10213 stats uri /admin?stats
10214 stats refresh 5s
10215
10216 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10217
10218
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010219stats hide-version
10220 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010222 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010223 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010224
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010225 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10226 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10227 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10228 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10229 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10230 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010231
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010232 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10233 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10234 unobvious parameters.
10235
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010236 Example :
10237 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10238 backend public_www
10239 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010240 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010241 stats hide-version
10242 stats scope .
10243 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010244 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010245 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10246 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010247
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010248 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10249 backend private_monitoring
10250 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010251 stats uri /admin?stats
10252 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010253
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010254 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010255
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010256
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010257stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10258 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10259 Access control for statistics
10260
10261 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10262 no | no | yes | yes
10263
10264 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10265 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10266 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10267 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10268 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10269 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10270
10271 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10272 instance.
10273
10274 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10275 about ACL usage.
10276
10277
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010278stats realm <realm>
10279 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010281 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010282 Arguments :
10283 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10284 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10285 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10286
10287 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10288 using a backslash ('\').
10289
10290 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10291 only related to authentication.
10292
10293 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10294 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10295 unobvious parameters.
10296
10297 Example :
10298 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10299 backend public_www
10300 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10301 stats enable
10302 stats hide-version
10303 stats scope .
10304 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010305 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010306 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10307 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10308
10309 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10310 backend private_monitoring
10311 stats enable
10312 stats uri /admin?stats
10313 stats refresh 5s
10314
10315 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10316
10317
10318stats refresh <delay>
10319 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010321 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010322 Arguments :
10323 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10324 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10325 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10326 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10327 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10328 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10329
10330 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10331 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10332 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010333 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010334
10335 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10336 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10337 unobvious parameters.
10338
10339 Example :
10340 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10341 backend public_www
10342 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10343 stats enable
10344 stats hide-version
10345 stats scope .
10346 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010347 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010348 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10349 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10350
10351 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10352 backend private_monitoring
10353 stats enable
10354 stats uri /admin?stats
10355 stats refresh 5s
10356
10357 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10358
10359
10360stats scope { <name> | "." }
10361 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010363 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010364 Arguments :
10365 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10366 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10367 section in which the statement appears.
10368
10369 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10370 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10371 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10372 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10373 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10374 exists.
10375
10376 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10377 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10378 unobvious parameters.
10379
10380 Example :
10381 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10382 backend public_www
10383 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10384 stats enable
10385 stats hide-version
10386 stats scope .
10387 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010388 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010389 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10390 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10391
10392 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10393 backend private_monitoring
10394 stats enable
10395 stats uri /admin?stats
10396 stats refresh 5s
10397
10398 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10399
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010400
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010401stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010402 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010404 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010405
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010406 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010407 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10408
10409 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10410 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10411
10412 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10413 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010414 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010415
10416 Example :
10417 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10418 backend private_monitoring
10419 stats enable
10420 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10421 stats uri /admin?stats
10422 stats refresh 5s
10423
10424 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10425 global section.
10426
10427
10428stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010429 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10431 yes | yes | yes | yes
10432 Arguments : none
10433
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010434 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010435 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10436 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10437 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10438 - IP (socket, server)
10439 - cookie (backend, server)
10440
10441 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10442 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010443 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010444
10445 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10446
10447
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010448stats show-modules
10449 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10451 yes | yes | yes | yes
10452 Arguments : none
10453
10454 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10455 values as a tooltip.
10456
10457 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10458 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10459 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10460
10461 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10462
10463
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010464stats show-node [ <name> ]
10465 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010467 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010468 Arguments:
10469 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10470 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10471
10472 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10473 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010474 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010475
10476 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10477 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10478 unobvious parameters.
10479
10480 Example:
10481 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10482 backend private_monitoring
10483 stats enable
10484 stats show-node Europe-1
10485 stats uri /admin?stats
10486 stats refresh 5s
10487
10488 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10489 section.
10490
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010491
10492stats uri <prefix>
10493 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010495 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010496 Arguments :
10497 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10498 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10499 query string.
10500
10501 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10502 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10503 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10504 possible to reach it in the application.
10505
10506 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010507 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010508 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10509 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10510 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10511 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10512
10513 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10514 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10515 an address or a port to statistics only.
10516
10517 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10518 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10519 unobvious parameters.
10520
10521 Example :
10522 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10523 backend public_www
10524 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10525 stats enable
10526 stats hide-version
10527 stats scope .
10528 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010529 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010530 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10531 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10532
10533 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10534 backend private_monitoring
10535 stats enable
10536 stats uri /admin?stats
10537 stats refresh 5s
10538
10539 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10540
10541
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010542stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10543 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010545 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010546
10547 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010548 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010549 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010550 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010551 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10552
10553 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10554 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10555 the "stick-table" statement.
10556
10557 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10558 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10559 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10560 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10561 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10562
10563 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10564 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10565 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10566 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10567 transformation rules.
10568
10569 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10570 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10571 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10572 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10573 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10574 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10575 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10576
10577 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10578 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10579 ACL based conditions.
10580
10581 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10582 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10583 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10584 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10585
10586 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10587 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10588 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10589 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10590
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010591 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10592 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010593 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010594
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010595 Example :
10596 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10597 # last 30 minutes
10598 backend pop
10599 mode tcp
10600 balance roundrobin
10601 stick store-request src
10602 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10603 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10604 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10605
10606 backend smtp
10607 mode tcp
10608 balance roundrobin
10609 stick match src table pop
10610 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10611 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10612
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010613 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010614 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010615
10616
10617stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10618 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10620 no | no | yes | yes
10621
10622 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10623 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10624 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10625 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10626
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010627 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10628 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010629 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010630
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010631 Examples :
10632 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010633 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010634
10635 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10636 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10637 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10638
10639
10640 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10641 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10642 backend http
10643 mode http
10644 balance roundrobin
10645 stick on src table https
10646 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10647 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10648 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10649
10650 backend https
10651 mode tcp
10652 balance roundrobin
10653 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10654 stick on src
10655 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10656 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10657
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010658 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010659
10660
10661stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10662 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10664 no | no | yes | yes
10665
10666 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010667 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010668 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010669 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010670 server is selected.
10671
10672 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10673 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10674 the "stick-table" statement.
10675
10676 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10677 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10678 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10679 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10680 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10681 address.
10682
10683 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10684 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10685 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10686 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10687 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10688 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10689 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10690 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10691 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10692 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10693
10694 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10695 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10696 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10697 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10698 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10699 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10700 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10701
10702 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10703 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10704 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10705 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10706
10707 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10708 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10709 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10710 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10711 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10712 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010713 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10714 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10715 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10716 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10717 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10718 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010719
10720 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10721 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10722 the request.
10723
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010724 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10725 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010726 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010727
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010728 Example :
10729 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10730 # last 30 minutes
10731 backend pop
10732 mode tcp
10733 balance roundrobin
10734 stick store-request src
10735 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10736 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10737 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10738
10739 backend smtp
10740 mode tcp
10741 balance roundrobin
10742 stick match src table pop
10743 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10744 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10745
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010746 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010747 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010748
10749
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010750stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070010751 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010752 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010753 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010755 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010756
10757 Arguments :
10758 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10759 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10760 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10761 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10762
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010763 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10764 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10765 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10766 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10767
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010768 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10769 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10770 instance.
10771
10772 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10773 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10774 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10775 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10776 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10777 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010778 to 32 characters.
10779
10780 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10781 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10782 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010783 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010784 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10785 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010786
10787 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010788 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10789 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010790 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10791 increase.
10792
10793 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010794 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10795 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10796 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010797
10798 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10799 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10800 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10801 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010802 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010803 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10804 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10805 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10806 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10807 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10808 parameter (see below).
10809
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010810 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10811 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10812 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10813 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10814 soft restart.
10815
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010816 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10817 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010818
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010819 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10820 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10821 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10822 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010010823 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010824 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010825 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10826 if not expiration delay is specified.
10827
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070010828 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
10829 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
10830 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
10831 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
10832 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
10833 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
10834 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
10835 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
10836 token.
10837
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010838 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10839 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10840 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10841 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010842 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10843 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10844 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10845 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10846 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10847 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10848 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10849 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10850 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10851 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10852 types and their arguments.
10853
10854 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10855 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10856 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10857 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10858
10859 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10860 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10861 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010862 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010863
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010864 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10865 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10866 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010867 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010868 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010869 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010870
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010871 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10872 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10873 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10874 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10875
10876 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10877 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10878 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10879 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10880 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10881 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10882
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010883 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10884 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10885 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10886 they were received.
10887
10888 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10889 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10890 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10891 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10892 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10893
10894 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10895 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10896 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10897 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10898 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10899
10900 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10901 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10902 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10903
10904 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10905 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10906 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10907 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10908 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10909
10910 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10911 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10912 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10913 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10914 the client side.
10915
10916 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10917 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10918 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10919 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10920 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10921 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10922 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10923
10924 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10925 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10926 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10927 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10928 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10929 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010930 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010931
10932 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10933 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10934 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10935 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10936 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10937 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10938
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010010939 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10940 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
10941 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10942 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
10943 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
10944
10945 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10946 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10947 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10948 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10949 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
10950 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10951
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010952 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010953 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010954 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10955 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10956
10957 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10958 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10959 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10960 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10961 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10962 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10963 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10964 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10965 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10966 recommended for better fairness.
10967
10968 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010969 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010970 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10971 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10972
10973 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10974 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10975 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10976 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10977 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10978 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10979 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10980 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10981 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10982 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010983
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010984 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10985 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010986 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10987 reference it.
10988
10989 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10990 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010991 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10992 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10993 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010994
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010995 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10996 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10997 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10998 something that can be ignored.
10999
11000 Example:
11001 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11002 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11003 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11004 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11005
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011006 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011007 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011008
11009
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011010stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011011 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11013 no | no | yes | yes
11014
11015 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011016 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011017 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011018 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011019 server is selected.
11020
11021 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11022 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11023 the "stick-table" statement.
11024
11025 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11026 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11027 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11028 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11029
11030 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11031 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11032 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11033 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11034 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11035 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011036 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011037 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11038 rules.
11039
11040 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11041 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11042 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11043 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11044 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11045 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11046 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11047
11048 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11049 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11050 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11051 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11052
11053 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11054 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11055 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11056 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11057 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11058 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011059 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11060 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11061 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11062 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11063 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11064 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11065 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11066 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11067 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011068
11069 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11070
11071 Example :
11072 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11073 backend https
11074 mode tcp
11075 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011076 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011077 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011078
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011079 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11080 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11081
11082 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11083 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11084 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11085
11086 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11087 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011088
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011089 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11090 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11091 # at offset 44.
11092
11093 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11094 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11095
11096 # Learn on response if server hello.
11097 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011098
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011099 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11100 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11101
11102 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11103 extraction.
11104
11105
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011106tcp-check comment <string>
11107 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11108 it fails.
11109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11110 yes | no | yes | yes
11111
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011112 Arguments :
11113 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11114 rule fails.
11115
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011116 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11117 user-friendly error reporting.
11118
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011119 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11120 "tcp-check expect".
11121
11122
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011123tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11124 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011125 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011126 Opens a new connection
11127 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011128 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011129
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011130 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011131 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11132
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011133 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011134 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011135
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011136 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011137 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11138 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011139 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011140
11141 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011142
11143 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11144
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011145 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11146
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011147 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11148
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011149 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11150
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011151 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11152 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11153 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11154 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11155
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011156 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11157 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11158 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11159 haproxy -vv.
11160
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011161 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011162
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011163 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11164 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11165 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11166
11167 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11168 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11169 of the sequence.
11170
11171 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11172 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11173 do.
11174
11175 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11176 unset-var or comment rules.
11177
11178 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011179 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11180 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11181 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11182 option tcp-check
11183 tcp-check connect
11184 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11185 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11186 tcp-check send \r\n
11187 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11188 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11189 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11190 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11191 tcp-check send \r\n
11192 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11193 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11194
11195 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11196 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011197 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011198 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11199 tcp-check connect port 143
11200 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11201 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11202
11203 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11204
11205
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011206tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011207 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011208 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011209 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011210 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011211 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011212 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011213
11214 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011215 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11216
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011217 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11218 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11219 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11220 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11221 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11222 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11223 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11224 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11225 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11226 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11227
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011228 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011229 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11230 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011231 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11232 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11233 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11234
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011235 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11236 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11237 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011238 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11239 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011240 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11241 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011242 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11243 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011244 By default "L7OK" is used.
11245
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011246 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11247 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011248 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11249 supported :
11250 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11251 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011252 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11253 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11254 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11255 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11256 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011257
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011258 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011259 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011260 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11261 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11262 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11263 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011264 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11265
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011266 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11267 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11268 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11269 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11270
11271 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11272 informational message reported in logs if an error
11273 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11274 log-format string.
11275
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011276 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11277 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11278 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11279 followed by some converters.
11280
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011281 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11282 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11283 with the usual backslash ('\').
11284 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011285 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011286 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11287 used upper or lower case.
11288
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011289 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11290
11291 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11292 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11293 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11294 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11295 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11296 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11297 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11298 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11299
11300 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11301 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11302 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11303 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11304 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11305 expression.
11306
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011307 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11308 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11309 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11310 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11311 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11312 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11313
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011314 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11315 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11316 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11317 this exact hexadecimal string.
11318 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11319
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011320 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11321 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11322 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11323 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11324 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11325 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11326 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11327 size.
11328
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011329 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11330 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11331 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11332 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11333 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11334 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11335 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11336 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11337 in a binary string before matching the response's
11338 buffer.
11339
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011340 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011341 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011342 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11343 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11344 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11345 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11346 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11347 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11348 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11349 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11350 the null character.
11351
11352 Examples :
11353 # perform a POP check
11354 option tcp-check
11355 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11356
11357 # perform an IMAP check
11358 option tcp-check
11359 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11360
11361 # look for the redis master server
11362 option tcp-check
11363 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011364 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011365 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11366 tcp-check expect string role:master
11367 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11368 tcp-check expect string +OK
11369
11370
11371 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011372 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011373
11374
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011375tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11376tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11377 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11378 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011379 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011380 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011381
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011382 Arguments :
11383 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11384
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011385 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11386 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011387
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011388 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11389 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011390
11391 Examples :
11392 # look for the redis master server
11393 option tcp-check
11394 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11395 tcp-check expect string role:master
11396
11397 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011398 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011399
11400
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011401tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11402tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11403 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11404 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011405 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011406 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011407
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011408 Arguments :
11409 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011410
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011411 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11412 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011413
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011414 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11415 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11416 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011417
11418 Examples :
11419 # redis check in binary
11420 option tcp-check
11421 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11422 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11423
11424
11425 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011426 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011427
11428
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011429tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011430 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011431 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011432 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011433
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011434 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011435 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11436 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11437 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11438 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11439 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11440 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11441 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11442 and '-'.
11443
11444 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11445
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011446 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011447 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11448
11449
11450tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011451 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011452 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011453 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011454
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011455 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011456 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11457 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11458 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11459 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11460 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11461 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11462 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11463 and '-'.
11464
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011465 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011466 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11467
11468
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011469tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11470 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11472 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011473 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011474 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11475 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011476
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011477 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011478
11479 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11480 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011481 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11482 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11483 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11484 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11485 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11486 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011487
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011488 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11489 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11490 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11491 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011492
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011493 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011494 - accept :
11495 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11496 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11497 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011498
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011499 - reject :
11500 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11501 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11502 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11503 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11504 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11505 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11506 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11507 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11508 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11509 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11510 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011511 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011512
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011513 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11514 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11515 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11516 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11517 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11518 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11519 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11520 hosts.
11521
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011522 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11523 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11524 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11525 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11526 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11527 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11528 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11529 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11530
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011531 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11532 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11533 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11534 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11535 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11536 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11537 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11538 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11539 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011540 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11541 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011542
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011543 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011544 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011545 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11546 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11547 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011548 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011549 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011550 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11551 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11552 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11553 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11554 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11555 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11556 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011557
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011558 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011559 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011560 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011561 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011562 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11563 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11564 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011565
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011566 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11567 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11568 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11569 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011570
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011571 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11572 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11573 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11574 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11575 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011576 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11577 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11578 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11579 layer7 information is extracted.
11580
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011581 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11582 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11583 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11584 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11585 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011586
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011587 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11588 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11589 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11590 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11591
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011592 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11593 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11594 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11595 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11596
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011597 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11598 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11599 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11600 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11601 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011602
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011603 - set-src <expr> :
11604 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11605 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11606 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011607 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011608
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011609 Arguments:
11610 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11611 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011612
11613 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011614 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11615
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011616 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11617 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011618
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011619 - set-src-port <expr> :
11620 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11621 expression.
11622
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011623 Arguments:
11624 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11625 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011626
11627 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011628 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11629
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011630 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11631 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11632 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011633
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011634 - set-dst <expr> :
11635 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11636 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11637 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11638 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11639 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11640
11641 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11642 followed by some converters.
11643
11644 Example:
11645
11646 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11647 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11648
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011649 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11650 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11651
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011652 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11653 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11654 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11655 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11656
11657
11658 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11659 followed by some converters.
11660
11661 Example:
11662
11663 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11664
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011665 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11666 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11667 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11668
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011669 - "silent-drop" :
11670 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011671 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011672 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11673 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11674 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11675 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11676 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011677 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11678 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011679 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11680 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011681 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011682 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11683 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11684 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11685 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11686
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011687 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11688 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11689 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011690
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011691 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11692 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11693 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011694
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011695 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011696 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011697 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011698
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011699 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11700 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11701 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011702
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011703 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011704 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11705 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011706
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011707 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11708
11709 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11710
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011711 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11712
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011713 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011714
11715
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011716tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11717 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011719 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011720 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011721 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11722 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011723
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011724 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011725
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011726 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011727 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11728 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11729 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11730 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011731
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011732 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11733 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11734 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11735 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011736 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11737 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11738 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11739 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11740 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11741 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011742 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011743 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011744
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011745 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11746 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11747 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11748 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011749
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011750 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011751 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011752 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011753 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11754 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011755 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011756 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011757 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011758 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011759 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011760 - set-dst <expr>
11761 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011762 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011763 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011764 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011765 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011766 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011767
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011768 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11769 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011770 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11771 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011772
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011773 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11774 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11775 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11776 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11777 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11778 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011779
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011780 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011781 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11782 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011783
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011784 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11785 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11786 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11787 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11788 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11789 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11790
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011791 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011792 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11793 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11794 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11795 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11796 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11797 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11798 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11799 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11800 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11801 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011802
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011803 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011804 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11805 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11806 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011807
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011808 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11809 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11810
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011811 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011812 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11813 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011814
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011815 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11816 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011817 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011818 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11819 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011820 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011821 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011822 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011823 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11824 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011825 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011826 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11827 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011828
11829 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11830 followed by some converters.
11831
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011832 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11833 <var-name>.
11834
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011835 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11836 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11837 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11838 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11839 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11840
11841 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11842 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11843 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11844 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11845 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11846 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11847 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11848 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11849 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11850 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11851 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11852
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011853 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11854 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11855 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11856 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11857 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11858
11859 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11860
11861 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11862
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011863 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11864 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11865 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11866 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11867 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11868 evaluated.
11869
11870 Example:
11871 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11872
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011873 Example:
11874
11875 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011876 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011877
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011878 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011879 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11880 # and reject everything else.
11881 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11882 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011883 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011884 tcp-request content reject
11885
11886 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011887 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11888 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11889 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011890 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011891
11892 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11893 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11894 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011895 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011896 tcp-request content reject
11897
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011898 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011899 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011900 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011901 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011902 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11903 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011904
11905 Example:
11906 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11907 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011908 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011909
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011910 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011911 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011912
11913 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011914 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011915 # protecting all our sites
11916 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011917 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11918 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011919 ...
11920 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11921
11922 backend http_dynamic
11923 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011924 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011925 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011926 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011927 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011928 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011929 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011930
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011931 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011932
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011933 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11934 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011935
11936
11937tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11938 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011940 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011941 Arguments :
11942 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11943 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11944 as explained at the top of this document.
11945
11946 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11947 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11948 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11949 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11950 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11951
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011952 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11953 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11954 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11955 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11956
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011957 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11958 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011959 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011960 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011961 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11962 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11963 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11964 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011965
11966 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11967 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11968 it pass through unaffected.
11969
11970 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11971 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11972 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011973 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011974 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11975 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011976 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11977 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11978 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011979
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011980 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011981 "timeout client".
11982
11983
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011984tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11985 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11987 no | no | yes | yes
11988 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011989 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11990 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011991
11992 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11993
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011994 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011995 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11996 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011997 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11998 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011999
12000 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12001
12002 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12003 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12004 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12005 inserted.
12006
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012007 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012008 - accept :
12009 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12010 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12011 the rules evaluation.
12012
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012013 - close :
12014 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12015 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12016 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12017 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12018 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12019 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012020 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012021 protocols.
12022
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012023 - reject :
12024 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12025 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012026 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012027
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012028 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12029 Sets a variable.
12030
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012031 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12032 Unsets a variable.
12033
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012034 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12035 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12036 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12037 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12038
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012039 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12040 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12041 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12042 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12043
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012044 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12045 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12046 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12047 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12048 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012049
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012050 - "silent-drop" :
12051 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012052 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012053 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12054 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12055 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12056 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12057 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012058 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12059 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012060 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12061 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012062 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012063 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12064 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12065 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12066 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12067
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012068 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12069 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12070
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012071 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12072 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12073 for changing the default action to a reject.
12074
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012075 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12076 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12077 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12078 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012079 period.
12080
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012081 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12082 declared inline.
12083
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012084 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12085 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012086 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012087 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12088 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012089 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012090 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012091 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012092 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12093 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012094 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012095 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12096 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012097
12098 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12099 followed by some converters.
12100
12101 Example:
12102
12103 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12104
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012105 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12106 <var-name>.
12107
12108 Example:
12109
12110 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12111
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012112 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12113 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12114 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12115 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12116 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12117
12118 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12119
12120 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12121
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012122 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12123
12124 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12125
12126
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012127tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12128 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12130 no | yes | yes | no
12131 Arguments :
12132 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12133 below.
12134
12135 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12136
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012137 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012138 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12139 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12140 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12141 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12142 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12143 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12144 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012145 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012146 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12147 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12148 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12149 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12150 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12151 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12152 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12153 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12154 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12155 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12156 instead.
12157
12158 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12159 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12160 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12161 rules which may be inserted.
12162
12163 Several types of actions are supported :
12164 - accept : the request is accepted
12165 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12166 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12167 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012168 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012169 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012170 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012171 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012172 - silent-drop
12173
12174 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12175 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12176 sections for a complete description.
12177
12178 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12179 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12180 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12181
12182 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12183 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12184 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12185 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12186 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12187
12188 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12189 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12190
12191 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12192 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12193 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12194
12195 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12196 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12197 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12198
12199 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12200 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12201 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12202
12203 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12204 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12205 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12206
12207 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12208
12209 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12210
12211
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012212tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12213 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12215 no | no | yes | yes
12216 Arguments :
12217 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12218 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12219 as explained at the top of this document.
12220
12221 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12222
12223
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012224timeout check <timeout>
12225 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12226 established.
12227
12228 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12229 yes | no | yes | yes
12230 Arguments:
12231 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12232 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12233 as explained at the top of this document.
12234
12235 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12236 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012237 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012238 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012239 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12240 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12241 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012242
12243 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12244 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12245
12246 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12247 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012248 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012249
12250 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12251 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12252 forget about it.
12253
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012254 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12255 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012256
12257
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012258timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012259 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12261 yes | yes | yes | no
12262 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012263 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012264 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12265 as explained at the top of this document.
12266
12267 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12268 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12269 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012270 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12271 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12272 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12273 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012274 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12275 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12276 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012277 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012278 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012279 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12280 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012281 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12282 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012283
12284 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12285 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12286 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12287 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012288 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012289 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12290
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012291 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012292
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012293 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012294
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012295
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012296timeout client-fin <timeout>
12297 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12299 yes | yes | yes | no
12300 Arguments :
12301 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12302 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12303 as explained at the top of this document.
12304
12305 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12306 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12307 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12308 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12309 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12310 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12311 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012312 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12313 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12314 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012315
12316 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12317 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12318 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12319
12320 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12321
12322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012323timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012324 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12326 yes | no | yes | yes
12327 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012328 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012329 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12330 as explained at the top of this document.
12331
12332 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012333 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012334 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012335 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012336 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12337 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012338
12339 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12340 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12341 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12342 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012343 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012344 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12345
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012346 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012347
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012348
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012349timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12350 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12352 yes | yes | yes | yes
12353 Arguments :
12354 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12355 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12356 as explained at the top of this document.
12357
12358 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12359 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12360 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12361 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12362 once the request has started to present itself.
12363
12364 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12365 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12366 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12367 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12368 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12369
12370 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12371 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12372 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12373 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12374
12375 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12376 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012377 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012378 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12379 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012380 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012381
12382 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12383 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12384 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12385 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12386
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012387 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12388 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012389 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12390
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012391 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12392
12393
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012394timeout http-request <timeout>
12395 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012397 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012398 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012399 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012400 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12401 as explained at the top of this document.
12402
12403 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12404 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12405 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12406 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12407 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12408 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12409 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012410 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12411 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12412 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12413 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012414 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012415 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12416 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012417
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012418 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12419 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12420 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12421 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12422 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012423 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012424
12425 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12426 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012427 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012428 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12429 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12430
12431 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012432 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12433 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12434 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012435
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012436 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012437 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012438
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012439
12440timeout queue <timeout>
12441 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12443 yes | no | yes | yes
12444 Arguments :
12445 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12446 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12447 as explained at the top of this document.
12448
12449 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12450 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12451 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12452 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12453 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12454
12455 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12456 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12457 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12458 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12459
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012460 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012461
12462
12463timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012464 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12466 yes | no | yes | yes
12467 Arguments :
12468 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12469 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12470 as explained at the top of this document.
12471
12472 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12473 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12474 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12475 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12476 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12477 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12478 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12479
12480 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12481 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12482 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12483 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12484 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012485 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012486 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012487 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12488 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012489 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12490 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012491
12492 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12493 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12494 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12495 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012496 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012497 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12498
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012499 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012500
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012501
12502timeout server-fin <timeout>
12503 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12505 yes | no | yes | yes
12506 Arguments :
12507 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12508 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12509 as explained at the top of this document.
12510
12511 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12512 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12513 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12514 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12515 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12516 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12517 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12518 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12519 situations, it should not be needed.
12520
12521 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12522 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12523 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12524
12525 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12526
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012527
12528timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012529 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12531 yes | yes | yes | yes
12532 Arguments :
12533 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12534 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12535 as explained at the top of this document.
12536
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012537 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12538 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12539 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012540
12541 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12542 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12543 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12544 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012545 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012546
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012547 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012548
12549
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012550timeout tunnel <timeout>
12551 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12553 yes | no | yes | yes
12554 Arguments :
12555 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12556 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12557 as explained at the top of this document.
12558
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012559 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012560 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12561 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12562 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012563 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12564 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012565 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12566 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12567 specified.
12568
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012569 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12570 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12571 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12572 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12573 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12574 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12575 state.
12576
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012577 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12578 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12579 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12580 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012581 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012582
12583 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12584 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12585 forget about it.
12586
12587 Example :
12588 defaults http
12589 option http-server-close
12590 timeout connect 5s
12591 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012592 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012593 timeout server 30s
12594 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12595
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012596 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012597
12598
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012599transparent (deprecated)
12600 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012602 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012603 Arguments : none
12604
12605 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12606 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12607 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12608 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12609 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12610 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12611 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12612 appropriate server.
12613
12614 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12615
12616 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12617 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12618
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012619 See also: "option transparent"
12620
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012621unique-id-format <string>
12622 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12624 yes | yes | yes | no
12625 Arguments :
12626 <string> is a log-format string.
12627
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012628 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12629 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12630 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12631 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012632
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012633 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12634 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12635 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12636 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12637 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12638 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12639 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12640 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012641
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012642 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12643 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012644
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012645 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012646
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012647 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012648
12649 will generate:
12650
12651 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12652
12653 See also: "unique-id-header"
12654
12655unique-id-header <name>
12656 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12658 yes | yes | yes | no
12659 Arguments :
12660 <name> is the name of the header.
12661
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012662 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12663 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012664
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012665 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012666
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012667 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012668 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12669
12670 will generate:
12671
12672 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12673
12674 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012675
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012676use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012677 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12679 no | yes | yes | no
12680 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012681 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12682 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012683
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012684 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12685 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012686
12687 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12688 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12689 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012690 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012691 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012692 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12693 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012694
12695 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12696 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12697 assign the backend.
12698
12699 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12700 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12701 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12702 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12703 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12704 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12705
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012706 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012707 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012708 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12709 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12710 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12711
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012712 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12713 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12714 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12715 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12716 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12717 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12718 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12719 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12720 cannot be forced from the request.
12721
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012722 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012723 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12724 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12725
12726 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12727 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012728
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012729use-fcgi-app <name>
12730 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12732 no | no | yes | yes
12733 Arguments :
12734 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12735
12736 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012737
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012738use-server <server> if <condition>
12739use-server <server> unless <condition>
12740 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12742 no | no | yes | yes
12743 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012744 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12745 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012746
12747 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12748
12749 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12750 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12751 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12752
12753 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12754 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12755 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12756 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12757 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12758 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12759 matches will assign the server.
12760
12761 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12762 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12763 with the next rules until one matches.
12764
12765 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12766 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12767 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12768 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12769
12770 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12771 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12772 stripped.
12773
12774 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12775 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012776 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12777 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12778 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012779
12780 Example :
12781 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12782 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12783 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12784 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012785 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012786 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012787 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012788 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12789 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12790
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012791 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12792 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12793 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12794 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012795 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012796 and we fall back to load balancing.
12797
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012798 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012799
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012800
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100128015. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012802--------------------------
12803
12804The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12805depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12806settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12807written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12808described in this section.
12809
12810
128115.1. Bind options
12812-----------------
12813
12814The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12815as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12816no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12817parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12818while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12819provided immediately after the setting name.
12820
12821The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12822
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012823accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12824 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12825 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12826 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12827 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12828 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12829 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12830 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12831 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12832 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012833 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12834 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12835 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012836
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012837accept-proxy
12838 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012839 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12840 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012841 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12842 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12843 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12844 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012845 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012846 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12847 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012848 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12849 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012850
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012851allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012852 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012853 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012854 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012855 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12856 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012857
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012858alpn <protocols>
12859 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12860 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12861 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012862 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012863 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012864 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12865 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12866 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12867 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12868 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12869 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12870 preference, like below :
12871
12872 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012873
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012874backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012875 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012876 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12877
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012878curves <curves>
12879 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12880 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12881 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12882 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12883 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12884 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12885
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012886ecdhe <named curve>
12887 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012888 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12889 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012890
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012891ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012892 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12893 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12894 client's certificate.
12895
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012896ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12897 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12898 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12899 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12900 error is ignored.
12901
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012902ca-sign-file <cafile>
12903 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12904 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12905 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12906 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12907 'generate-certificates' for details.
12908
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012909ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012910 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12911 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12912 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12913 'generate-certificates' for details.
12914
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012915ca-verify-file <cafile>
12916 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12917 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12918 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12919 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12920 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12921
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012922ciphers <ciphers>
12923 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12924 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012925 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012926 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012927 information and recommendations see e.g.
12928 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12929 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12930 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12931
12932ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12933 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12934 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12935 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12936 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012937 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12938 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012939
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012940crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012941 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12942 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12943 to verify client's certificate.
12944
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012945crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012946 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12947 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12948 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12949 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12950 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012951 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12952 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012953
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012954 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12955 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12956
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012957 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12958 are loaded.
12959
12960 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012961 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12962 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12963 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12964 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12965 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12966 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12967 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012968 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012969
12970 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12971 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12972 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12973 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012974 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12975 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012976
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012977 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012978
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012979 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012980 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012981 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12982 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012983 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12984 clients).
12985
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012986 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12987 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12988 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12989 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12990 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12991 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12992 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12993 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12994 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12995 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12996 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12997 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12998 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12999
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013000 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
13001 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13002 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13003 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13004 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13005
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013006 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13007 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13008 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13009 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013010
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013011 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13012 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13013 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013014
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013015crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013016 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013017 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013018 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013019 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013020
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013021crt-list <file>
13022 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013023 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13024 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013025
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013026 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13027
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013028 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13029 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13030 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13031 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13032 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013033
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013034 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013035 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13036 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13037 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13038 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13039 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013040 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13041 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13042 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013043
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013044 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13045 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13046 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013047
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013048 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13049
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013050 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
13051 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
13052 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13053 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13054 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13055 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13056 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13057 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013058
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013059 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013060 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013061 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013062 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013063 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013064 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013065
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013066defer-accept
13067 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13068 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13069 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013070 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013071 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13072 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13073 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13074 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13075 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13076 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13077 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13078
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013079expose-fd listeners
13080 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13081 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013082 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13083 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013084 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013085
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013086force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013087 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013088 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013089 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013090 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013091
13092force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013093 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013094 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013095 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013096
13097force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013098 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013099 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013100 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013101
13102force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013103 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013104 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013105 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013106
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013107force-tlsv13
13108 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13109 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013110 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013111
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013112generate-certificates
13113 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13114 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13115 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13116 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13117 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13118 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13119 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13120 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13121 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13122 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13123 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13124
13125 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13126 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013127 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013128 certificate is used many times.
13129
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013130gid <gid>
13131 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13132 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13133 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13134 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13135 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13136
13137group <group>
13138 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13139 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13140 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13141 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13142 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13143
13144id <id>
13145 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13146 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13147 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13148 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13149
13150interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013151 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13152 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13153 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13154 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13155 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13156 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013157 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13158 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13159 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13160 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13161 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13162 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013163
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013164level <level>
13165 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13166 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13167 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013168 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013169 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13170 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13171 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013172 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013173 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013174 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013175 all counters).
13176
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013177severity-output <format>
13178 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13179 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13180 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13181 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13182 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13183 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13184 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13185 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13186 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13187 rfc5424 convention.
13188
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013189maxconn <maxconn>
13190 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13191 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13192 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13193 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13194 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13195 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13196 eat all memory.
13197
13198mode <mode>
13199 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13200 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13201 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13202 UNIX sockets.
13203
13204mss <maxseg>
13205 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13206 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13207 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13208 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13209 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13210 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13211 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13212 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13213 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13214 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13215 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13216
13217name <name>
13218 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13219 page.
13220
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013221namespace <name>
13222 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13223 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13224 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13225 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13226
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013227nice <nice>
13228 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13229 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13230 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13231 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13232 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13233 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13234 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13235 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13236 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13237 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13238 one for an RDP socket.
13239
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013240no-ca-names
13241 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13242 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013243 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013244
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013245no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013246 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013247 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013248 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013249 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013250 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13251 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013252
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013253no-tls-tickets
13254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13255 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13256 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013257 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13258 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013259 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13260 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13261 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013262
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013263no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013264 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013265 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013266 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013267 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013268 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13269 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013270
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013271no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013272 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013273 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013274 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013275 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013276 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13277 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013278
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013279no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013280 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013281 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013282 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013283 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013284 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13285 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013286
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013287no-tlsv13
13288 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13289 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13290 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13291 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013292 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13293 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013294
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013295npn <protocols>
13296 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13297 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13298 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013299 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013300 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013301 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13302 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13303 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13304 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13305 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013306
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013307prefer-client-ciphers
13308 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13309 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13310 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013311 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13312 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13313 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013314
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013315process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013316 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013317 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013318 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013319 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13320 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13321 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13322 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013323 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013324 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13325 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13326 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13327 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13328 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013329
13330 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13331
13332 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13333 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13334 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13335 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13336 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13337 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13338 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13339 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013340
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013341proto <name>
13342 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13343 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13344 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
13345 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013346 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013347 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013348 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013349 h2" on the bind line.
13350
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013351ssl
13352 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013353 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013354 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13355 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013356 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13357 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013358
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013359ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13360 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013361 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13362 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13363 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013364 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13365
13366ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013367 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13368 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13369 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13370 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013371
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013372strict-sni
13373 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13374 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13375 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13376 See the "crt" option for more information.
13377
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013378tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013379 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013380 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13381 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013382 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013383 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13384 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13385 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13386 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13387 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13388 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13389 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13390
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013391tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013392 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013393 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13394 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13395 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13396 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13397 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13398 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13399 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013400 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13401 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13402 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013403
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013404tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13405 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013406 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13407 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13408 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13409 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13410 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13411 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13412 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13413 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13414 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13415 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013416 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13417 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13418
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013419transparent
13420 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13421 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13422 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13423 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13424 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13425 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13426 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13427 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13428 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13429 so check for support with your vendor.
13430
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013431v4v6
13432 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13433 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13434 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13435 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013436 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013437
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013438v6only
13439 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13440 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13441 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013442 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13443 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013444
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013445uid <uid>
13446 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13447 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13448 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13449 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13450 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13451
13452user <user>
13453 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13454 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13455 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13456 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13457 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13458
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013459verify [none|optional|required]
13460 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13461 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13462 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13463 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13464 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013465 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13466 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13467 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13468 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013469
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200134705.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013471------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013472
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013473The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13474which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13475arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13476settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13477after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13478Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13479address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013480
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013481 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013482 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013483
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013484Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13485keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13486
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013487The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013488
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013489addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013490 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013491 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13492 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13493 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13494 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13495 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013496
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013497agent-check
13498 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013499 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013500 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13501 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13502 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013503
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013504 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013505 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013506 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13507 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13508 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013509
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013510 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13511 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13512 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13513 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13514 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013515
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013516 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013517 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013518
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013519 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13520 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13521 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013522
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013523 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13524 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13525 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013526
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013527 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013528 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13529 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13530 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13531 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013532 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013533 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013534
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013535 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13536 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013537
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013538 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13539 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13540 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13541 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13542 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13543 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13544 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13545 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13546 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013547
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013548 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13549 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013550 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13551 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13552 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013553 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013554
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013555 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013556 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013557
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013558agent-send <string>
13559 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13560 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13561 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13562 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13563 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13564
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013565agent-inter <delay>
13566 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13567 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13568
13569 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13570 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13571 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13572 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13573 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13574 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13575 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13576 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13577 of backends use the same servers.
13578
13579 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13580
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013581agent-addr <addr>
13582 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13583
13584 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13585 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13586 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13587 hostname, it will be resolved.
13588
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013589agent-port <port>
13590 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13591
13592 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13593
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013594allow-0rtt
13595 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013596 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13597 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013598
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013599alpn <protocols>
13600 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13601 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13602 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013603 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013604 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13605 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13606 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13607 now obsolete NPN extension.
13608 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13609 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13610
13611 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013613backup
13614 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13615 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13616 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13617 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013618 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13619 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013620
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013621ca-file <cafile>
13622 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13623 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13624 server's certificate.
13625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013626check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013627 This option enables health checks on a server:
13628 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13629 considered available.
13630 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13631 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13632 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13633 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13634 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13635 set.
13636 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13637 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13638 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13639 exchanges succeed.
13640
13641 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13642 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13643 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13644 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13645 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013646 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013647 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13648
13649 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13650 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13651
13652 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13653 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13654
13655 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13656 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13657 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13658 available.
13659
13660 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13661 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13662 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13663
13664 Example:
13665 # simple tcp check
13666 backend foo
13667 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13668 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13669 backend foo
13670 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13671 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13672 backend foo
13673 option tcp-check
13674 tcp-check connect
13675 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013676
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013677check-send-proxy
13678 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13679 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13680 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13681 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13682 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13683 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13684 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13685
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013686check-alpn <protocols>
13687 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13688 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13689 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13690
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013691check-proto <name>
13692 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13693 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13694 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13695 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013696 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013697 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13698 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13699
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013700check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013701 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013702 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13703 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013704
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013705check-ssl
13706 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13707 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13708 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13709 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013710 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013711 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13712 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013713 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013714 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13715 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013716
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013717check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013718 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013719 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13720 for normal traffic.
13721
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013722ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013723 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13724 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13725 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013726 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13727 information and recommendations see e.g.
13728 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13729 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13730 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013731
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013732ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13733 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13734 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13735 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13736 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013737 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13738 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13739 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013740
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013741cookie <value>
13742 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13743 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13744 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13745 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13746 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13747 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13748 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13749
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013750crl-file <crlfile>
13751 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13752 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13753 to verify server's certificate.
13754
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013755crt <cert>
13756 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13757 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13758 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13759 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13760 certificate request.
13761
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013762disabled
13763 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13764 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13765 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13766 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13767 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013768 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013769
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013770enabled
13771 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13772 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13773 default value.
13774 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13775 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013776
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013777error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013778 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13779 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13780 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013781
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013782 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013783
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013784fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013785 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13786 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13787 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13788
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013789force-sslv3
13790 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13791 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013792 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013793 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013794
13795force-tlsv10
13796 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013797 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013798 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013799
13800force-tlsv11
13801 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013802 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013803 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013804
13805force-tlsv12
13806 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013807 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013808 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013809
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013810force-tlsv13
13811 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13812 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013813 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013815id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013816 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13817 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13818 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013819
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013820init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13821 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13822 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013823 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013824 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13825 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13826 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13827 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13828 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13829 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13830 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13831 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13832 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013833 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013834 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13835 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13836 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13837 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13838 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13839 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013840 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013841
13842 Example:
13843 defaults
13844 # never fail on address resolution
13845 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13846
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013847inter <delay>
13848fastinter <delay>
13849downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013850 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13851 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13852 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13853 between checks depending on the server state :
13854
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013855 Server state | Interval used
13856 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13857 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13858 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13859 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13860 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13861 or yet unchecked. |
13862 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13863 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13864 | "inter" otherwise.
13865 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013866
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013867 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13868 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13869 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13870 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013871 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13872 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13873 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13874 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13875 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013876
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013877log-proto <logproto>
13878 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13879 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13880 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13881 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13882
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013883maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013884 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13885 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013886 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13887 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013888 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13889 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13890 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13891 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13892
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013893 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13894 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13895 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13896 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13897 than 50 concurrent requests.
13898
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013899maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013900 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13901 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13902 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13903 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020013904 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
13905 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
13906 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
13907 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
13908 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
13909 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
13910 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013911
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013912max-reuse <count>
13913 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13914 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13915 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13916 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13917 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13918 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13919 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13920 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13921
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013922minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013923 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13924 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13925 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13926 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13927 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13928 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013929 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013930 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013931
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013932namespace <name>
13933 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13934 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13935 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13936 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13937
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013938no-agent-check
13939 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13940 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13941 default value.
13942 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13943 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13944
13945no-backup
13946 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13947 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13948 default value.
13949 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13950 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13951
13952no-check
13953 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13954 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13955 default value.
13956 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13957 "default-server" "check" setting.
13958
13959no-check-ssl
13960 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13961 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13962 default value.
13963 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13964 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13965
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013966no-send-proxy
13967 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13968 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13969 default value.
13970 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13971 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13972
13973no-send-proxy-v2
13974 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13975 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13976 default value.
13977 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13978 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13979
13980no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13981 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13982 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13983 default value.
13984 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13985 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13986
13987no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13988 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13989 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13990 default value.
13991 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13992 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13993
13994no-ssl
13995 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13996 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13997 default value.
13998 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13999 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14000
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014001 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14002 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14003 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14004
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014005no-ssl-reuse
14006 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14007 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14008 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14009 and for paranoid users.
14010
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014011no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014012 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14013 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014014 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014015
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014016 Supported in default-server: No
14017
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014018no-tls-tickets
14019 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14020 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14021 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014022 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14023 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014024 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14025 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14026 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014027 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014028
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014029no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014030 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014031 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14032 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014033 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14034 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014035 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014036
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014037 Supported in default-server: No
14038
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014039no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014040 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014041 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14042 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014043 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14044 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014045 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014046
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014047 Supported in default-server: No
14048
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014049no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014050 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014051 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14052 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014053 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14054 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014055 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014056
14057 Supported in default-server: No
14058
14059no-tlsv13
14060 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14061 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14062 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14063 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14064 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014065 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014066
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014067 Supported in default-server: No
14068
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014069no-verifyhost
14070 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14071 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14072 default value.
14073 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14074 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014075
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014076no-tfo
14077 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14078 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14079 default value.
14080 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14081 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14082
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014083non-stick
14084 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14085 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14086 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14087
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014088npn <protocols>
14089 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14090 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14091 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014092 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014093 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14094 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14095 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14096
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014097observe <mode>
14098 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14099 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14100 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14101 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14102 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14103 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014104 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014105
14106 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14107
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014108on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014109 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14110 Currently, four modes are available:
14111 - fastinter: force fastinter
14112 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14113 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14114 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14115 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14116
14117 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14118
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014119on-marked-down <action>
14120 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14121 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014122 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14123 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14124 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14125 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14126 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14127 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14128 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14129 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014130
14131 Actions are disabled by default
14132
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014133on-marked-up <action>
14134 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14135 Currently one action is available:
14136 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14137 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14138 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14139 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014140 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14141 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014142 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14143 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14144
14145 Actions are disabled by default
14146
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014147pool-low-conn <max>
14148 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14149 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14150 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14151 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14152 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14153 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14154 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14155 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14156 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14157 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014158 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14159 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14160 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14161 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014162
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014163pool-max-conn <max>
14164 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14165 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14166 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14167 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14168 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14169 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14170
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014171pool-purge-delay <delay>
14172 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014173 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014174 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014175
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014176port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014177 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014178 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14179 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14180 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14181 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14182 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014183
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014184proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014185 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14186 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14187 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
14188 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014189 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014190 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14191
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014192redir <prefix>
14193 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14194 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14195 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14196 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14197 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14198 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14199 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14200 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014201 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014202 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014203 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14204 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14205 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14206 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14207
14208 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14209
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014210rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014211 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14212 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14213 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14214
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014215resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14216 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14217 server.
14218
14219 Available options:
14220
14221 * allow-dup-ip
14222 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14223 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14224 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14225 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14226 For such case, simply enable this option.
14227 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14228
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014229 * ignore-weight
14230 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14231 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14232 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14233
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014234 * prevent-dup-ip
14235 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14236 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14237 same fqdn.
14238 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14239
14240 Example:
14241 backend b_myapp
14242 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14243 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14244 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14245
14246 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14247 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14248 it
14249 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14250 different address
14251
14252 Default value: not set
14253
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014254resolve-prefer <family>
14255 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14256 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14257 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14258 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14259
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014260 Default value: ipv6
14261
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014262 Example:
14263
14264 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014265
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014266resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014267 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014268 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014269 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014270 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14271 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014272 configured network, another address is selected.
14273
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014274 Example:
14275
14276 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014277
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014278resolvers <id>
14279 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14280 hostname.
14281
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014282 Example:
14283
14284 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014285
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014286 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014287
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014288send-proxy
14289 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14290 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14291 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14292 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014293 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14294 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14295 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14296 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14297 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14298 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14299 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14300 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14301 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14302 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014303 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14304 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014305
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014306send-proxy-v2
14307 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14308 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14309 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14310 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014311 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14312 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14313 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14314 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014315
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014316proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014317 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14318 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14319
14320 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14321 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14322 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14323 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14324 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14325 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14326 connection is supported).
14327 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14328 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14329 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14330 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14331 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14332 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14333 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014334
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014335send-proxy-v2-ssl
14336 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14337 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14338 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14339 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14340 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14341 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14342 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014343 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14344 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014345
14346send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14347 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14348 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14349 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14350 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14351 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14352 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14353 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14354 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014355 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14356 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014357
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014358slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014359 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14360 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14361 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14362 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14363 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14364 parameters :
14365
14366 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14367 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14368
14369 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14370 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14371 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14372 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14373
14374 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14375 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14376 seen as failed.
14377
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014378sni <expression>
14379 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14380 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14381 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14382 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014383 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14384 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014385 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014386 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14387 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014388
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014389source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014390source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014391source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014392 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14393 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14394 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14395 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14396
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014397 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14398 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14399 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14400 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14401 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14402 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14403 server.
14404
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014405 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14406 specifying the source address without port(s).
14407
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014408ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014409 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14410 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14411 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14412 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14413 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14414 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014415 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14416 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014417
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014418ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14419 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14420 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14421 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14422
14423ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14424 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14425 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14426 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14427
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014428ssl-reuse
14429 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14430 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14431 default value.
14432 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14433 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14434
14435stick
14436 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14437 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14438 default value.
14439 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14440 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014441
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014442socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014443 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014444 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14445 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14446
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014447tcp-ut <delay>
14448 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14449 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14450 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014451 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014452 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14453 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14454 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14455 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14456 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14457 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14458 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14459 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14460 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14461
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014462tfo
14463 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14464 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14465 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14466 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14467 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014468 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014469
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014470track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014471 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14472 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14473 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14474 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014475 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14476
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014477tls-tickets
14478 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14479 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14480 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014481 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14482 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14483 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014484 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014485 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014486
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014487verify [none|required]
14488 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014489 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014490 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14491 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014492 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014493 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14494 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14495 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14496 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14497 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14498 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14499 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14500 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014501
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014502verifyhost <hostname>
14503 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014504 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14505 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14506 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14507 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14508 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14509 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14510 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14511 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014512
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014513weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014514 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14515 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14516 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014517 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14518 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14519 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14520 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14521 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14522 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014523
14524
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200145255.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14526-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014527
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014528HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14529using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014530configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014531This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14532can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14533workload.
14534This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14535resolution at run time.
14536Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14537carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14538
14539
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200145405.3.1. Global overview
14541----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014542
14543As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14544different steps of the process life:
14545
14546 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14547 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14548 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14549
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014550 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14551 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014552
14553A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14554 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14555 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14556 resolution to know this new IP.
14557
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014558When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014559HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014560SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14561from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14562will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14563will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014564
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014565A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014566 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014567 first valid response.
14568
14569 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14570 servers return an error.
14571
14572
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200145735.3.2. The resolvers section
14574----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014575
14576This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014577HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14578contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014579
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014580When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14581uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14582is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14583answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14584
14585When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014586used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014587
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014588 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14589 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14590 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014591
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014592 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14593 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014594
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014595 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14596 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14597 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014598
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014599For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14600following scenarios are possible:
14601
14602 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14603 ignored
14604
14605 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14606 applied
14607
14608 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14609 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14610
14611 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14612 retries the query with a new type
14613
14614 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14615 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014616
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014617As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14618a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014619<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014620
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014621
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014622resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014623 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014624
14625A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14626
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014627accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014628 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014629 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014630 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14631 by RFC 6891)
14632
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010014633 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
14634 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
14635 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
14636 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
14637 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
14638 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014639
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014640nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010014641 UDP DNS server description:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014642 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14643 <ip> : IP address of the server
14644 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14645
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010014646server <name> <address> [param*]
14647 Used to configure a DNS TCP or stream server. This supports for all
14648 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of these parameters
14649 are irrelevant for DNS resolving. Note: currently 4 queries are pipelined
14650 on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed every
14651 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
14652 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
14653
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014654parse-resolv-conf
14655 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14656 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14657 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14658
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014659hold <status> <period>
14660 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14661 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014662 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014663 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014664 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14665 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14666 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14667
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014668 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014669
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014670resolve_retries <nb>
14671 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14672 giving up.
14673 Default value: 3
14674
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014675 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14676 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14677 type.
14678
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014679timeout <event> <time>
14680 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14681 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14682 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014683 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14684 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014685 Default value: 1s
14686 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014687 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014688 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014689 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14690 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14691
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014692 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014693
14694 resolvers mydns
14695 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14696 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014697 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014698 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014699 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014700 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014701 hold other 30s
14702 hold refused 30s
14703 hold nx 30s
14704 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014705 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014706 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014707
14708
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200147096. Cache
14710---------
14711
14712HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14713(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14714RAM.
14715
14716The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14717this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14718
14719If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14720independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14721when we try to allocate a new one.
14722
14723The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14724
14725It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14726"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14727for more details.
14728
14729When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14730replaced by "<CACHE>".
14731
14732
147336.1. Limitation
14734----------------
14735
14736The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14737
14738- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010014739- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
14740 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
14741 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014742- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14743- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010014744- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
14745 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
14746 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010014747- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
14748 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010014749- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
14750 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
14751 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014752
14753- If the request is not a GET
14754- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14755- If the request contains an Authorization header
14756
14757
147586.2. Setup
14759-----------
14760
14761To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14762the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14763
14764
147656.2.1. Cache section
14766---------------------
14767
14768cache <name>
14769 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14770 size of cache is mandatory.
14771
14772total-max-size <megabytes>
14773 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14774 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14775
14776max-object-size <bytes>
14777 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14778 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14779 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14780
14781max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010014782 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014783 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14784 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14785 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14786 default.
14787
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010014788process-vary <on/off>
14789 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010014790 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
14791 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
14792 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010014793 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010014794
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010014795max-secondary-entries <number>
14796 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
14797 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
14798 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
14799
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014800
148016.2.2. Proxy section
14802---------------------
14803
14804http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14805 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14806 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14807 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14808 after this one.
14809
14810http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14811 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14812 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14813 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14814 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14815
14816
14817Example:
14818
14819 backend bck1
14820 mode http
14821
14822 http-request cache-use foobar
14823 http-response cache-store foobar
14824 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14825
14826 cache foobar
14827 total-max-size 4
14828 max-age 240
14829
14830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200148317. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14832----------------------------------
14833
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014834HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014835client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14836The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14837these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14838but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14839data called patterns.
14840
14841
148427.1. ACL basics
14843---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014844
14845The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14846content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14847from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14848simple :
14849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014850 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014851 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014852 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14853 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014855The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14856adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014857
14858In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014860 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014861
14862This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14863Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14864and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014865an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14866conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14867as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14868are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014869
14870ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14871'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14872which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14873
14874There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14875performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014877The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14878specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14879this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014880methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14881ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014882
14883Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14884 - boolean
14885 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14886 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14887 - string
14888 - data block
14889
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014890Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14891converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14892would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14893The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14894which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14895
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014896Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14897keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14898fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14899which are summarized in the table below :
14900
14901 +---------------------+-----------------+
14902 | Sample or converter | Default |
14903 | output type | matching method |
14904 +---------------------+-----------------+
14905 | boolean | bool |
14906 +---------------------+-----------------+
14907 | integer | int |
14908 +---------------------+-----------------+
14909 | ip | ip |
14910 +---------------------+-----------------+
14911 | string | str |
14912 +---------------------+-----------------+
14913 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14914 +---------------------+-----------------+
14915
14916Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14917matching method, see below.
14918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014919The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14920 - boolean
14921 - integer or integer range
14922 - IP address / network
14923 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14924 - regular expression
14925 - hex block
14926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014927The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14928
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014929 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14930 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014931 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014932 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014933 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014934 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014935 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014937The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14938read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14939if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14940lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14941will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14942beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14943a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14944lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14945exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14946
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014947The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14948parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14949ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14950a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14951check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14952
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014953The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14954socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14955file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014957Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14958loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14959
14960 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14961
14962In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14963the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14964case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14965as well.
14966
14967The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14968sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14969do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14970methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14971is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014972obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014973followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14974default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14975that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14976string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14977
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014978The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14979By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14980string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14981resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14982server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014983waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014984flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14985function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014987There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14988sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14989be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014990
14991 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14992 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014993 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14994 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14995 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14996 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014997
14998 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14999 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015000 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015001
15002 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015003 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015004
15005 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015006 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015007
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015008 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015009 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15010
15011 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15012 binary or string samples.
15013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015014 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15015 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015017 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15018 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15019 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015021 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15022 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015024 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15025 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015027 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15028 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015030 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15031 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015032 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015034 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15035 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15036 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015037
15038For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15039request, it is possible to do :
15040
15041 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15042
15043In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15044buffer, one would use the following acl :
15045
15046 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15047
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015048On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15049possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15050
15051 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015053All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15054criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15055method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15056to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15057criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15058the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015060If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015061the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15062For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015064 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15065 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15066 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15067 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015068
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015069
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015070The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15071types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15072combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15073brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15074default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015076 +-------------------------------------------------+
15077 | Input sample type |
15078 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015079 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015080 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15081 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15082 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015083 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015084 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015085 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015086 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015087 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015088 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015089 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015090 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015091 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015092 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015093 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015094 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015095 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015096 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015097 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015098 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015099 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015100 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015101 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015102 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015103 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015104 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15105 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15106 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015107
15108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151097.1.1. Matching booleans
15110------------------------
15111
15112In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15113Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15114When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15115that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15116
15117Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15118return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15119"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15120
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151227.1.2. Matching integers
15123------------------------
15124
15125Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15126enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15127to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15128
15129Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15130matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15131lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015132
15133For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15134unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15135representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15136
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015137As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15138two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15139instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15140ranges and operators.
15141
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015142For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015143operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15144Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15145of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015146
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015147Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015148
15149 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15150 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15151 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15152 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15153 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15154
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015155For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015156
15157 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15158
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015159This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15160
15161 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15162
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151647.1.3. Matching strings
15165-----------------------
15166
15167String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15168different forms :
15169
15170 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015171 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015172
15173 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015174 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015175
15176 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15177 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15178
15179 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15180 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15181
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015182 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015183 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15184 matches.
15185
15186 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15187 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15188 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015189
15190String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15191exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15192characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15193string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15194to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015195before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015196
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015197Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15198(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15199Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15200
15201Example:
15202 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15203 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15204
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200152067.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15207---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015208
15209Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15210they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15211possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15212passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15213the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015214the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15215match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015216
15217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200152187.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15219-------------------------------------
15220
15221It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15222not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15223a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15224to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15225digits may be used upper or lower case.
15226
15227Example :
15228 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15229 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15230
15231
152327.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15233---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015234
15235IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15236netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15237within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015238host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015239difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15240at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15241does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15242parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015243
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015244The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15245abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15246
15247 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15248 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15249 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15250 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15251 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15252 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15253 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15254 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15255
15256Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15257192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15258
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015259IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15260Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15261trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15262IPv6 patterns.
15263
15264HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15265following situations :
15266 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15267 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15268 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15269 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15270 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15271 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15272 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15273 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15274 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15275 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015277
152787.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15279----------------------------------
15280
15281Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15282combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15283
15284 - AND (implicit)
15285 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15286 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015288A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015290 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015292Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15293indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015295For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15296"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15297requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15298is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15299
15300 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015301 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15302 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15303 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015304
15305To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15306and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15307
15308 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15309 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15310 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15311 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15312
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015313 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015314 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15315 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15316 use_backend www if host_www
15317
15318It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15319expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15320be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15321the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15322
15323 The following rule :
15324
15325 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015326 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015327
15328 Can also be written that way :
15329
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015330 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015331
15332It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15333to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15334simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15335sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15336good use is the following :
15337
15338 With named ACLs :
15339
15340 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15341 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15342 monitor fail if site_dead
15343
15344 With anonymous ACLs :
15345
15346 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15347
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015348See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15349keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015350
15351
153527.3. Fetching samples
15353---------------------
15354
15355Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15356against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15357sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15358ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15359of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15360available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15361
15362This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15363Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15364compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15365deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15366
15367The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15368matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15369method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15370indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15371
15372As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15373when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15374mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15375the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15376ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15377
15378Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15379multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15380when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015381incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15382are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015383is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15384all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15385
15386Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15387 - name
15388 - name(arg1)
15389 - name(arg1,arg2)
15390
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015391
153927.3.1. Converters
15393-----------------
15394
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015395Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15396of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15397is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15398was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015399has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015400unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15401
15402These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15403sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15404the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015405support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015406
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015407A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15408support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15409supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15410(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15411bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015413The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015414
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001541551d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15416 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15417 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15418 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15419 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15420 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15421
15422 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015423 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15424 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015425 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15426 frontend http-in
15427 bind *:8081
15428 default_backend servers
15429 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15430 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15431
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015432add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015433 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015434 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015435 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15436 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015437 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015438 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15439 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15440 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15441 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015442 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015443 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015444
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015445aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15446 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15447 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15448 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15449 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15450 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15451 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15452
15453 Example:
15454 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15455 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15456
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015457and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015458 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015459 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015460 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15461 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015462 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015463 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15464 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15465 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15466 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015467 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015468 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015469
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015470b64dec
15471 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15472 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
15473
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015474base64
15475 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015476 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015477 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
15478
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015479bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015480 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015481 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015482 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015483 presence of a flag).
15484
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015485bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15486 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15487 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015488 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015489
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015490concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15491 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15492 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15493 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15494 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15495 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15496 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15497 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15498 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15499 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15500 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015501 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015502 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015503 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15504 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015505
15506 Example:
15507 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15508 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15509 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015510 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015511 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15512
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015513cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015514 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15515 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015516
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015517crc32([<avalanche>])
15518 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15519 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15520 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15521 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15522 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15523 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15524 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15525 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15526 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15527 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015528 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15529
15530crc32c([<avalanche>])
15531 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15532 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15533 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15534 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15535 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15536 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15537 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15538 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015539
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015540cut_crlf
15541 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15542 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15543 updated.
15544
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015545da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015546 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15547 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15548 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15549 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015550 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015551 configuration language.
15552
15553 Example:
15554 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015555 bind *:8881
15556 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015557 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015558
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015559debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15560 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15561 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15562 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15563 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15564 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15565 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15566 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15567 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15568 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15569 printable sample types.
15570
15571 Example:
15572 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015573
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015574digest(<algorithm>)
15575 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15576 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15577
15578 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15579 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15580
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015581div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015582 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15583 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015584 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015585 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15586 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015587 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015588 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15589 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15590 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15591 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015592 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015593 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015594
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015595djb2([<avalanche>])
15596 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15597 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15598 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15599 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15600 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15601 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15602 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015603 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15604 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015605
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015606even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015607 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015608 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15609
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015610field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15611 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15612 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15613 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15614 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15615 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15616 fields.
15617
15618 Example :
15619 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15620 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15621 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15622 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15623 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015624
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015625fix_is_valid
15626 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
15627 Information eXchange):
15628
15629 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
15630 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050015631 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015632 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010015633 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015634 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
15635 checksum
15636
15637 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15638 the server can be parsed.
15639
15640 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
15641 message, false if not.
15642
15643 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
15644
15645 Example:
15646 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15647 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15648
15649fix_tag_value(<tag>)
15650 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
15651 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
15652 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
15653 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050015654 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015655 added.
15656
15657 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15658 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
15659 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
15660 fix_is_valid converter.
15661
15662 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
15663
15664 Example:
15665 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15666 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15667 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
15668 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
15669 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
15670
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015671hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015672 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015673 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015674 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015675 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015676
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015677hex2i
15678 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015679 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015680
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015681htonl
15682 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15683 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15684 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15685 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15686
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010015687hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015688 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15689 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15690 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15691 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15692
15693 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15694 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15695
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015696http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015697 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15698 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015699 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15700 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15701 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15702 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15703 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15704 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15705 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15706 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015707
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015708iif(<true>,<false>)
15709 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15710 string otherwise.
15711
15712 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015713 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015714
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015715in_table(<table>)
15716 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15717 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15718 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015719 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015720 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15721
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010015722ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015723 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015724 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015725 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15726 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15727 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15728 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15729 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015730
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015731json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015732 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015733 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015734 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015735 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15736 of errors:
15737 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15738 bytes, ...)
15739 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15740 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15741
15742 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15743 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15744 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15745 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15746 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15747 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015748 - "ascii" : never fails;
15749 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15750 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015751 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015752 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015753 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15754 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15755
15756 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015757 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015758
15759 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015760 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015761 capture request header user-agent len 150
15762 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015763
15764 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15765 GET / HTTP/1.0
15766 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15767
15768 Output log:
15769 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15770
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015771language(<value>[,<default>])
15772 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15773 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15774 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15775 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15776 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15777 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15778 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15779 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15780 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015781 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015782 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15783 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015784
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015785 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015786
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015787 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15788 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015789
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015790 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15791 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15792 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15793 use_backend spanish if es
15794 use_backend french if fr
15795 use_backend english if en
15796 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015797
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015798length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015799 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15800 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15801 type. The result is of type integer.
15802
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015803lower
15804 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15805 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15806 type. The result is of type string.
15807
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015808ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15809 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15810 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15811 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15812 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15813 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15814 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15815
15816 Example :
15817
15818 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015819 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015820 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15821
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015822ltrim(<chars>)
15823 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15824 representation of the input sample.
15825
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015826map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15827map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15828map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15829 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15830 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15831 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15832 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15833 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15834 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15835 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15836 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015837
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015838 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15839 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15840 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015841
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015842 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015843 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015844
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015845 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15846 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15847 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15848 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015849 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15850 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015851 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15852 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15853 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15854 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15855 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15856 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15857 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15858 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015859 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15860 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15861 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015862 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15863 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15864 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15865 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15866 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015867
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015868 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15869 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15870 the corresponding match text.
15871
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015872 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15873 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15874 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15875 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15876 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015877
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015878 Example :
15879
15880 # this is a comment and is ignored
15881 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15882 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15883 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15884 | | | `---------- value
15885 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15886 | `---------------------------- key
15887 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15888
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015889mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015890 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15891 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015892 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015893 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015894 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015895 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15896 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15897 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15898 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015899 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015900 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015901
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010015902mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname or property ID>)
15903 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
15904 <packettype>.
15905 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
15906 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
15907 from.
15908 Supported string and integers can be found here:
15909 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
15910 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
15911
15912 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
15913 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
15914 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
15915 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
15916
15917 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
15918 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
15919 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15920 packets only):
15921 17: Session Expiry Interval
15922 33: Receive Maximum
15923 39: Maximum Packet Size
15924 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15925 25: Request Response Information
15926 23: Request Problem Information
15927 21: Authentication Method
15928 22: Authentication Data
15929 18: Will Delay Interval
15930 1: Payload Format Indicator
15931 2: Message Expiry Interval
15932 3: Content Type
15933 8: Response Topic
15934 9: Correlation Data
15935 Not supported yet:
15936 38: User Property
15937
15938 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
15939 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15940 packets only):
15941 17: Session Expiry Interval
15942 33: Receive Maximum
15943 36: Maximum QoS
15944 37: Retain Available
15945 39: Maximum Packet Size
15946 18: Assigned Client Identifier
15947 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15948 31: Reason String
15949 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
15950 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
15951 42: Shared Subscription Available
15952 19: Server Keep Alive
15953 26: Response Information
15954 28: Server Reference
15955 21: Authentication Method
15956 22: Authentication Data
15957 Not supported yet:
15958 38: User Property
15959
15960 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15961 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15962 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15963 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15964
15965 Example:
15966
15967 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15968 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15969 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
15970 if data_in_buffer
15971 # do the same as above
15972 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15973 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
15974 if data_in_buffer
15975
15976mqtt_is_valid
15977 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
15978
15979 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15980 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15981 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15982 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15983
15984 Example:
15985
15986 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15987 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
15988
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015989mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015990 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015991 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15992 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015993 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015994 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015995 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015996 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15997 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15998 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15999 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016000 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016001 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016002
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016003nbsrv
16004 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16005 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16006 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16007 map lookup.
16008
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016009neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016010 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16011 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16012 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16013 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016014
16015not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016016 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016017 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016018 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016019 absence of a flag).
16020
16021odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016022 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016023 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16024
16025or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016026 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016027 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016028 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16029 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016030 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016031 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16032 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16033 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16034 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016035 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016036 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016037
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016038protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16039 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16040 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16041 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16042 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16043 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16044 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16045 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16046 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16047 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16048 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16049 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16050
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016051regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016052 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16053 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16054 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16055 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16056 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16057 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16058 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16059 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16060 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016061 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16062 of characters with other ones.
16063
16064 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16065 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16066 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16067 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16068 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16069 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016070
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016071 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016072
16073 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16074 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16075 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016076 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016077
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016078 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16079 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16080
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016081 # capture groups and backreferences
16082 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016083 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016084 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16085
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016086capture-req(<id>)
16087 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16088 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16089
16090 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016091 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16092 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016093
16094capture-res(<id>)
16095 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16096 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16097
16098 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016099 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16100 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016101
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016102rtrim(<chars>)
16103 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16104 of the input sample.
16105
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016106sdbm([<avalanche>])
16107 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16108 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16109 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16110 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16111 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16112 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16113 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016114 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16115 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016116
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016117secure_memcmp(<var>)
16118 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16119 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16120 match.
16121
16122 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16123 performed in constant time.
16124
16125 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16126 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16127
16128 Example :
16129
16130 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16131 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16132 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16133 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16134
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016135set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016136 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16137 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16138 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016139 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016140 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16141 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016142 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016143 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16144 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016145 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016146 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016147
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016148sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016149 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016150 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16151
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016152sha2([<bits>])
16153 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16154 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16155
16156 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16157 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16158
16159 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16160 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16161
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016162srv_queue
16163 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16164 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16165 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16166 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16167 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16168
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016169strcmp(<var>)
16170 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16171 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16172 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16173 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16174 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16175 shorter).
16176
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016177 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16178 strings in constant time.
16179
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016180 Example :
16181
16182 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16183 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16184 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16185
16186
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016187sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016188 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16189 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016190 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016191 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16192 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016193 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016194 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16195 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016196 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016197 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16198 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016199 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016200 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016201
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016202table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16203 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16204 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16205 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16206 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16207 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16208 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16209
16210
16211table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16212 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16213 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16214 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16215 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16216 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16217 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16218
16219table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16220 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16221 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016222 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016223 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16224 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16225
16226table_conn_cur(<table>)
16227 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16228 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16229 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16230 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16231 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16232
16233table_conn_rate(<table>)
16234 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16235 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16236 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16237 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16238 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16239
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016240table_gpt0(<table>)
16241 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16242 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16243 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16244 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16245 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16246
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016247table_gpc0(<table>)
16248 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16249 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16250 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16251 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16252 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16253
16254table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16255 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16256 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16257 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16258 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16259 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16260 sample fetch keyword.
16261
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016262table_gpc1(<table>)
16263 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16264 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16265 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16266 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16267 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16268
16269table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16270 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16271 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16272 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16273 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16274 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16275 sample fetch keyword.
16276
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016277table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16278 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16279 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016280 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016281 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16282 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16283
16284table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16285 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16286 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16287 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16288 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16289 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16290 keyword.
16291
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016292table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16293 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16294 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16295 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16296 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16297 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16298
16299table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16300 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16301 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16302 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16303 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16304 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16305 keyword.
16306
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016307table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16308 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16309 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016310 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016311 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16312 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16313
16314table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16315 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16316 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16317 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16318 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16319 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16320 keyword.
16321
16322table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16323 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16324 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016325 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016326 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16327 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16328 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16329 keyword.
16330
16331table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16332 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16333 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016334 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016335 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16336 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16337 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16338 keyword.
16339
16340table_server_id(<table>)
16341 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16342 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16343 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16344 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16345 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16346 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16347
16348table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16349 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16350 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016351 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016352 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16353 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16354 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16355 keyword.
16356
16357table_sess_rate(<table>)
16358 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16359 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16360 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16361 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16362 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16363 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16364 keyword.
16365
16366table_trackers(<table>)
16367 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16368 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16369 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16370 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16371 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16372 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16373 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16374 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16375 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16376 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16377
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016378upper
16379 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16380 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16381 type. The result is of type string.
16382
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016383url_dec([<in_form>])
16384 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16385 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16386 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16387 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16388 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16389 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016390
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016391url_enc([<enc_type>])
16392 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16393 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16394 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16395 optional argument is here for future changes.
16396
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016397ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016398 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016399 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16400 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16401 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016402 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16403 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16404 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16405 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016406 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016407 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16408 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016409
16410 Example:
16411 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16412 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16413
16414 message Point {
16415 int32 latitude = 1;
16416 int32 longitude = 2;
16417 }
16418
16419 message PPoint {
16420 Point point = 59;
16421 }
16422
16423 message Rectangle {
16424 // One corner of the rectangle.
16425 PPoint lo = 48;
16426 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16427 PPoint hi = 49;
16428 }
16429
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016430 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16431 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16432 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016433
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016434 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16435 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016436 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016437 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16438
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016439 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016440
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016441 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016442
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016443 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16444 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16445 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016446
16447 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16448 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16449 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16450
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016451 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16452 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16453 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016454
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016455
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016456unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016457 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16458 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16459 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16460 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16461 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16462 response),
16463 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16464 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16465 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16466 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16467
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016468utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16469 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16470 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16471 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16472 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16473 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16474 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16475
16476 Example :
16477
16478 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016479 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016480 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16481
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016482word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16483 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16484 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16485 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016486 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016487 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16488 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16489
16490 Example :
16491 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16492 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16493 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16494 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16495 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016496 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016497
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016498wt6([<avalanche>])
16499 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16500 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16501 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16502 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16503 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16504 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16505 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016506 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16507 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016508
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016509xor(<value>)
16510 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016511 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016512 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016513 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016514 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016515 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16516 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016517 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016518 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16519 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016520 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016521 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016522
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010016523xxh3([<seed>])
16524 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
16525 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
16526 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
16527 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
16528 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
16529 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
16530 considered as cryptographically secure.
16531
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016532xxh32([<seed>])
16533 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16534 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16535 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16536 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16537 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16538 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16539 as cryptographically secure.
16540
16541xxh64([<seed>])
16542 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16543 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16544 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16545 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16546 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16547 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16548 as cryptographically secure.
16549
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016550
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200165517.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016552--------------------------------------------
16553
16554A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16555not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16556"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16557The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16558
16559always_false : boolean
16560 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16561 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16562
16563always_true : boolean
16564 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16565 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16566
16567avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016568 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016569 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16570 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16571 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16572 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16573 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16574 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16575 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16576 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16577 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16578 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16579 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16580 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16581 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016583be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016584 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16585 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16586 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16587 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016588 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16589
16590be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16591 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16592 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16593 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16594 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16595 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016596 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16597 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016598
16599 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16600 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16601 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016603be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16604 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16605 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16606 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016607 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016608 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16609 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016610
16611 Example :
16612 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16613 backend dynamic
16614 mode http
16615 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16616 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016617
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016618bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016619 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16620 of the string.
16621
16622bool(<bool>) : bool
16623 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16624 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016626connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16627 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016628 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016629 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16630 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016631
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016632 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016633 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016634 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16635
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016636 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16637 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016638
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016639 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016640 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016641 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016642 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016643 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016644 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016645 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016646
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016647 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16648 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016649 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016650 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016651
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016652cpu_calls : integer
16653 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16654 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16655 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16656 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16657 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16658 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16659
16660cpu_ns_avg : integer
16661 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16662 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16663 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16664 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16665 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16666 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16667 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16668 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16669 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16670 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16671 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16672
16673cpu_ns_tot : integer
16674 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16675 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16676 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16677 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16678 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16679 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16680 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16681 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16682 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16683 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16684 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16685 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16686 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16687
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016688date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016689 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016690
16691 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16692 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16693 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016694 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16695
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016696 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16697 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16698 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16699 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16700 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16701
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016702 Example :
16703
16704 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16705 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016706
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016707 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16708 # millisecond granularity
16709 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16710
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016711date_us : integer
16712 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16713 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16714 from the same timeval structure.
16715
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016716distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16717 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16718 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16719 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16720 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16721 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16722 list of supported tokens.
16723
16724distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16725 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16726 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16727 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16728 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16729 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16730 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16731 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16732 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16733 supported tokens.
16734
16735 Example :
16736 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16737 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16738 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16739 # send large files to the big farm
16740 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16741
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016742env(<name>) : string
16743 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16744 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16745 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16746 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16747 certain way.
16748
16749 Examples :
16750 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16751 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16752
16753 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16754 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016756fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16757 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016758 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16759 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016760 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16761 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016762 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016763 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16764 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016765
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016766fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16767 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16768 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16769 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016771fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16772 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16773 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16774 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16775 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16776 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16777 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16778 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16779 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016780
16781 Example :
16782 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16783 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16784 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16785 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16786 frontend mail
16787 bind :25
16788 mode tcp
16789 maxconn 100
16790 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16791 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16792 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16793 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016794
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016795hostname : string
16796 Returns the system hostname.
16797
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016798int(<integer>) : signed integer
16799 Returns a signed integer.
16800
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016801ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16802 Returns an ipv4.
16803
16804ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16805 Returns an ipv6.
16806
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016807lat_ns_avg : integer
16808 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16809 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16810 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16811 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16812 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16813 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16814 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16815 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16816 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016817 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16818 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16819 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16820 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16821 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16822 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016823
16824lat_ns_tot : integer
16825 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16826 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16827 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16828 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16829 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16830 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16831 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16832 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16833 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016834 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16835 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16836 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16837 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16838 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016839 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16840 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16841 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16842 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16843 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16844 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16845
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016846meth(<method>) : method
16847 Returns a method.
16848
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016849nbproc : integer
16850 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16851 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16852 and debugging purposes.
16853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016854nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16855 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16856 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16857 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016858 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16859 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16860 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016861
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016862prio_class : integer
16863 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16864 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16865 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16866
16867prio_offset : integer
16868 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16869 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16870 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16871 set-priority-offset".
16872
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016873proc : integer
16874 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16875 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16876 debugging purposes.
16877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016878queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016879 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16880 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16881 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016882 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16883 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16884 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16885 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16886 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16887
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016888rand([<range>]) : integer
16889 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16890 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16891 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16892 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16893 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16894
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016895uuid([<version>]) : string
16896 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16897 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16898 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016900srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16901 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16902 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16903 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16904 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16905 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016906 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16907 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16908
16909srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16910 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16911 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16912 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16913 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16914 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16915 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16916 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16917
16918 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16919 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016920
16921srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16922 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16923 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16924 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016925 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016926 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16927 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16928 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16929
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016930srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16931 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16932 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16933 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16934 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16935 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16936 fetch methods.
16937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016938srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16939 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16940 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016941 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016942 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16943 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016944 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016945 overloading servers).
16946
16947 Example :
16948 # Redirect to a separate back
16949 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16950 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16951 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16952
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016953srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16954 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16955 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16956 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16957
16958srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16959 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16960 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16961 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16962
16963srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16964 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16965 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16966 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16967
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016968stopping : boolean
16969 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16970 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16971 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16972
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016973str(<string>) : string
16974 Returns a string.
16975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016976table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16977 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16978 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16979
16980table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16981 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16982 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16983 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16984
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016985thread : integer
16986 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16987 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16988 and debugging purposes.
16989
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016990var(<var-name>) : undefined
16991 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016992 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16993 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016994 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016995 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16996 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016997 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016998 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16999 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017000 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017001 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017002
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200170037.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017004----------------------------------
17005
17006The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
17007closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17008methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17009sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17010TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017011the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17012counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017013"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17014used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17015can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17016Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17017table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17018tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17019currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017020
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017021bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017022 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17023 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17024 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017026be_id : integer
17027 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017028 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17029 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017030
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017031be_name : string
17032 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017033 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17034 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017035
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017036be_server_timeout : integer
17037 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17038 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17039 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17040
17041be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17042 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17043 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17044 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17045
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017046cur_server_timeout : integer
17047 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17048 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17049 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17050
17051cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17052 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17053 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17054 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017056dst : ip
17057 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17058 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17059 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17060 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017061 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17062 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17063 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17064 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17065 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17066 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017067
17068dst_conn : integer
17069 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17070 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17071 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17072 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17073 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17074 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17075 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17076 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017077
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017078dst_is_local : boolean
17079 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17080 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17081 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17082 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017083 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017084 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17085 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17086 it only once per connection.
17087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017088dst_port : integer
17089 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17090 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17091 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17092 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17093 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17094 an HTTP header.
17095
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017096fc_http_major : integer
17097 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17098 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17099 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17100
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017101fc_pp_authority : string
17102 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17103 if any.
17104
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017105fc_pp_unique_id : string
17106 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17107 if any.
17108
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017109fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17110 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17111 header.
17112
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017113fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17114 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17115 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17116 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17117 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17118 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17119 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17120
17121fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17122 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17123 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17124 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17125 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17126 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17127 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17128
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017129fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017130 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17131 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17132 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17133 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17134
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017135fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017136 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17137 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17138 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17139 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17140
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017141fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017142 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17143 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17144 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17145 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17146
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017147fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017148 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17149 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17150 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17151 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17152
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017153fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017154 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17155 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17156 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17157 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17158
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017159fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017160 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17161 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17162 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17163 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17164
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017165fe_defbe : string
17166 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17167 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017169fe_id : integer
17170 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017171 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017172 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17173
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017174fe_name : string
17175 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17176 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17177 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17178
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017179fe_client_timeout : integer
17180 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17181 current frontend.
17182
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017183sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017184sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17185sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17186sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017187 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17188 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17189 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17190
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017191sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017192sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17193sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17194sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017195 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17196 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17197 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17198
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017199sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017200sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17201sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17202sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017203 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17204 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017205 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17206 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17207 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017208
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017209 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017210 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17211 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017212 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17213 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17214 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017215 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17216 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17217
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017218sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17219sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17220sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17221sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17222 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17223 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17224 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17225 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17226 when a first ACL was verified.
17227
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017228sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017229sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17230sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17231sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017232 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017233 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17234
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017235sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017236sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17237sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17238sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017239 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17240 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17241 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17242
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017243sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017244sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17245sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17246sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017247 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17248 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17249 See also src_conn_rate.
17250
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017251sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017252sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17253sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17254sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017255 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017256 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017257
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017258sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17259sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17260sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17261sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17262 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17263 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17264
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017265sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17266sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17267sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17268sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17269 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17270 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17271
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017272sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017273sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17274sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17275sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017276 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17277 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17278 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017279 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17280 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17281 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017282
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017283sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17284sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17285sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17286sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17287 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17288 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17289 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17290 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17291 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17292 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17293
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017294sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017295sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17296sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17297sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017298 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017299 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17300 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17301
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017302sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017303sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17304sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17305sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017306 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17307 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17308 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17309 src_http_err_rate.
17310
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017311sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17312sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17313sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17314sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17315 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17316 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17317 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17318
17319sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17320sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17321sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17322sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17323 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17324 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17325 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17326 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17327
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017328sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017329sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17330sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17331sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017332 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017333 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17334 src_http_req_cnt.
17335
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017336sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017337sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17338sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17339sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017340 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17341 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17342 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17343 src_http_req_rate.
17344
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017345sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017346sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17347sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17348sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017349 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017350 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17351 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17352 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17353 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017354
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017355 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017356 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17357 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017358 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17359
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017360sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17361sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17362sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17363sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17364 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17365 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17366 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17367 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17368 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17369
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017370sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017371sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17372sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17373sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017374 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17375 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17376 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017377
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017378sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017379sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17380sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17381sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017382 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17383 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17384 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017385
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017386sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017387sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17388sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17389sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017390 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017391 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17392 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17393 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017394 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017395 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17396
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017397sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017398sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17399sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17400sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017401 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17402 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17403 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17404 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17405 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017406 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017407
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017408sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017409sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17410sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17411sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017412 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17413 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17414 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17415
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017416sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017417sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17418sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17419sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017420 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17421 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017422 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017423 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17424 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017425 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17426 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17427 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017429so_id : integer
17430 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17431 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17432 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017433
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017434so_name : string
17435 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17436 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17437 strings instead of integers.
17438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017439src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017440 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017441 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17442 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17443 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017444 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17445 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17446 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017447 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17448 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17449 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17450 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17451 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17452 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17453 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017454
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017455 Example:
17456 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17457 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017459src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17460 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17461 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17462 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017463 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017465src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17466 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17467 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017468 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017469 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017471src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17472 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17473 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17474 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17475 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17476 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17477 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017478
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017479 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017480 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17481 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17482 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17483 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017484 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017485 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17486 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17487
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017488src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17489 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17490 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17491 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17492 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17493 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17494 was verified.
17495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017496src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017497 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017498 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017499 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017500 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017502src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017503 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017504 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17505 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017506 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017508src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17509 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17510 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17511 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017512 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017514src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017515 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017516 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017517 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017518 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017519
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017520src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17521 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17522 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17523 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17524 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17525
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017526src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17527 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17528 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17529 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17530 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017532src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017533 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017534 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017535 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17536 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017537 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17538 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17539 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017540
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017541src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17542 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17543 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17544 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17545 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17546 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17547 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17548 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017550src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017551 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017552 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017553 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017554 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017555 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017557src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17558 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17559 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17560 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17561 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017562 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017563
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017564src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17565 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
17566 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050017567 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017568 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
17569 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17570
17571src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17572 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
17573 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17574 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
17575 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
17576 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
17577 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
17578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017579src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017580 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017581 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17582 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017583 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017585src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17586 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17587 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17588 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017589 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017590 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017592src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17593 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17594 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17595 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017596 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017597 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17598 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017599
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017600 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017601 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017602 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017603 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017604
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017605src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17606 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17607 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17608 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17609 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17610 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17611 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17612
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017613src_is_local : boolean
17614 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17615 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17616 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17617 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017618 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017619 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17620 once per connection.
17621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017622src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017623 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17624 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17625 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17626 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17627 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017629src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017630 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17631 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17632 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17633 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17634 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017636src_port : integer
17637 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17638 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17639 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17640 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017642src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017643 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017644 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17645 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17646 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017647 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017649src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17650 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17651 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17652 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17653 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017654 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017656src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17657 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17658 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17659 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17660 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17661 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17662 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17663 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17664 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017665
17666 Example :
17667 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17668 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17669 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17670 listen ssh
17671 bind :22
17672 mode tcp
17673 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017674 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017675 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017676 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017678srv_id : integer
17679 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17680 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017681 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017682
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017683srv_name : string
17684 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17685 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017686 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017687
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200176887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017689----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017691The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17692closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17693when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17694usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017695future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017696
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001769751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17698 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17699 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17700 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17701 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17702 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17703
17704 Example :
17705 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17706 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17707 # the request.
17708 frontend http-in
17709 bind *:8081
17710 default_backend servers
17711 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17712 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17713
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017714ssl_bc : boolean
17715 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17716 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017717 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17718 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017719
17720ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17721 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017722 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17723 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017724
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017725ssl_bc_alpn : string
17726 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17727 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017728 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017729 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17730 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17731 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17732 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17733 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017734 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17735 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017736
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017737ssl_bc_cipher : string
17738 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017739 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17740 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017741
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017742ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17743 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17744 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17745 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017746 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017747
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017748ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17749 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17750 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017751 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17752 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017753
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017754ssl_bc_npn : string
17755 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17756 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017757 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017758 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17759 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17760 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17761 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017762 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17763 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017764
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017765ssl_bc_protocol : string
17766 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017767 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17768 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017769
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017770ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017771 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017772 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017773 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17774 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017775
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017776ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17777 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17778 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17779 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017780 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017781
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017782ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17783 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17784 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017785 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17786 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017787
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017788ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17789 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17790 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17791 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017792 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017793
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017794ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17795 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017796 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17797 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017799ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17800 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17801 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17802 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17803 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17804 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017806ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17807 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17808 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17809 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17810 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017811
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017812ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017813 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17814 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17815 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050017816 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017817 does not support resumed sessions.
17818
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017819ssl_c_der : binary
17820 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17821 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17822 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017824ssl_c_err : integer
17825 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17826 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17827 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17828 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17829 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017830
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017831ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017832 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17833 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17834 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17835 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17836 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17837 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17838 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17839 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017840 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17841 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17842 LDAP v3.
17843 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17844 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017846ssl_c_key_alg : string
17847 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17848 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17849 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017851ssl_c_notafter : string
17852 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17853 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17854 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017856ssl_c_notbefore : string
17857 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17858 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17859 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017860
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017861ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017862 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17863 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17864 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17865 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17866 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17867 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17868 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17869 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017870 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17871 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17872 LDAP v3.
17873 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17874 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017876ssl_c_serial : binary
17877 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17878 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17879 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017881ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17882 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17883 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17884 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017885 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17886 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17887
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017888 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017889 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017891ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17892 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17893 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17894 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017896ssl_c_used : boolean
17897 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17898 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017900ssl_c_verify : integer
17901 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17902 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17903 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17904 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017906ssl_c_version : integer
17907 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17908 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017909
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017910ssl_f_der : binary
17911 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17912 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17913 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17914
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017915ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017916 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17917 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17918 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17919 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017920 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017921 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17922 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17923 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017924 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17925 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17926 LDAP v3.
17927 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17928 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017930ssl_f_key_alg : string
17931 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17932 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17933 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017935ssl_f_notafter : string
17936 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17937 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17938 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017940ssl_f_notbefore : string
17941 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17942 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17943 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017944
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017945ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017946 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17947 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17948 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17949 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17950 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17951 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17952 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17953 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017954 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17955 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17956 LDAP v3.
17957 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17958 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017960ssl_f_serial : binary
17961 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17962 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17963 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017964
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017965ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17966 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17967 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17968 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017970ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17971 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17972 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17973 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017975ssl_f_version : integer
17976 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17977 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17978
17979ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017980 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17981 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17982 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017984 Example :
17985 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17986 listen http-https
17987 bind :80
17988 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17989 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17990
17991ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17992 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17993 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17994
17995ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017996 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017997 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17998 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17999 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18000 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18001 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18002 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18003 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18004 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018006ssl_fc_cipher : string
18007 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18008 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018009
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018010ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18011 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18012 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018013 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018014
18015ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18016 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18017 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018018 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018019
18020ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18021 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18022 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18023 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018024 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018025 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018026
18027ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18028 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18029 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018030 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018031
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018032ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18033 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18034 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18035 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18036
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018037ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18038 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18039 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18040 transport layer.
18041 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18042 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18043 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18044 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18045
18046ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18047 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18048 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18049 transport layer.
18050 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18051 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18052 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18053 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18054
18055ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18056 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18057 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18058 transport layer.
18059 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18060 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18061 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18062 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18063
18064ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18065 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18066 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18067 transport layer.
18068 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18069 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18070 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18071 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18072
18073ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18074 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18075 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18076 transport layer.
18077 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18078 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18079 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18080 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018082ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018083 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18084 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018085 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18086 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18087 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18088 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018089
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018090ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18091 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18092 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18093 wait until the handshake happened.
18094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018095ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18096 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018097 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18098 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018099 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018100 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018101
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018102ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018103 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018104 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18105 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018107ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018108 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018109 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
18110 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18111 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18112 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18113 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18114 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18115 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018117ssl_fc_protocol : string
18118 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18119 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018120
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018121ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018122 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018123 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18124 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018125
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018126ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18127 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18128 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18129 transport layer.
18130 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18131 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18132 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18133 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18134
18135ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18136 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18137 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18138 transport layer.
18139 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18140 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18141 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18142 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18143
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018144ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18145 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18146 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18147 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018149ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18150 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18151 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18152 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18153 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018154
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018155ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18156 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18157 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18158 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18159 BoringSSL.
18160
18161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018162ssl_fc_sni : string
18163 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18164 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
18165 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
18166 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18167 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18168
18169 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
18170 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
18171 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018172 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018173 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018175 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018176 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18177 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018179ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18180 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18181 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018182
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018183ssl_s_der : binary
18184 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18185 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18186 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18187
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018188ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18189 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18190 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18191 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018192 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018193 does not support resumed sessions.
18194
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018195ssl_s_key_alg : string
18196 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18197 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18198 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18199
18200ssl_s_notafter : string
18201 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18202 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18203 transport layer.
18204
18205ssl_s_notbefore : string
18206 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18207 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18208 transport layer.
18209
18210ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18211 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18212 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18213 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18214 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18215 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18216 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018217 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18218 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018219 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18220 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18221 LDAP v3.
18222 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18223 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18224
18225ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18226 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18227 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18228 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18229 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18230 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18231 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018232 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18233 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018234 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18235 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18236 LDAP v3.
18237 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18238 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18239
18240ssl_s_serial : binary
18241 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18242 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18243 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18244
18245ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18246 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18247 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18248 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18249
18250ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18251 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18252 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18253 layer.
18254
18255ssl_s_version : integer
18256 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18257 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018258
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200182597.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018260------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018262Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18263sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18264only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18265For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18266be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18267can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18268sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18269for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18270content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018272payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018273 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018274 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18275 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018277payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18278 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018279 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018280 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018282req.len : integer
18283req_len : integer (deprecated)
18284 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18285 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18286 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18287 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18288 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18289 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18290 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18291 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018293req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18294 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018295 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18296 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18297 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18298 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018300 ACL alternatives :
18301 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018303req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18304 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18305 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18306 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18307 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018309 ACL alternatives :
18310 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018312 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018314req.proto_http : boolean
18315req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18316 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18317 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18318 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18319 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18320 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18321 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18322 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018324 Example:
18325 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18326 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18327 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018328 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018330req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18331rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18332 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18333 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18334 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18335 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18336 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18337 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18338 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018340 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18341 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18342 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18343 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18344 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18345 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018347 ACL derivatives :
18348 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018350 Example :
18351 listen tse-farm
18352 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18353 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18354 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18355 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18356 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18357 persist rdp-cookie
18358 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18359 # This is only useful makes sense if
18360 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18361 stick-table type string size 204800
18362 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18363 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18364 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018366 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18367 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018369req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18370rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18371 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18372 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18373 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18374 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018376 ACL derivatives :
18377 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018378
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018379req.ssl_alpn : string
18380 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18381 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18382 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18383 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18384 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18385 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018386 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018387
18388 Examples :
18389 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18390 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18391 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018392 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018393 default_backend bk_default
18394
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018395req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18396 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18397 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018398 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18399 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18400 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18401 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18402 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018404req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18405req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18406 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18407 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18408 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18409 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18410 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18411 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18412 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018414req.ssl_sni : string
18415req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18416 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18417 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18418 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18419 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18420 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018421 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18422 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18423 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18424 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18425 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18426 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18427 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18428 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18429 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018431 ACL derivatives :
18432 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018434 Examples :
18435 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18436 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18437 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18438 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18439 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018440
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018441req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18442 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18443 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18444 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18445 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18446 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18447 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18448 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18449 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18450 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018452req.ssl_ver : integer
18453req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18454 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18455 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18456 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18457 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18458 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18459 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18460 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018461 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018462 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018464 ACL derivatives :
18465 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018466
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018467res.len : integer
18468 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18469 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18470 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18471 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18472 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18473 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18474 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018475 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018477res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18478 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018479 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018480 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018481 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018482 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018484res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18485 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18486 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18487 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018488 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18489 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018491 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018492
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018493res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18494rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18495 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18496 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18497 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18498 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18499 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18500 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18501 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018503wait_end : boolean
18504 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18505 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018506 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018507 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18508 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018509 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018510 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18511 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018513 Examples :
18514 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18515 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18516 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018518 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18519 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18520 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18521 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18522 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18523 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18524 tcp-request content reject
18525
18526
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200185277.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018528--------------------------------------
18529
18530It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18531This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18532data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18533its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18534HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18535content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18536to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18537more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18538response are indexed.
18539
18540base : string
18541 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18542 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18543 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18544 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18545 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18546 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18547 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18548 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18549
18550 ACL derivatives :
18551 base : exact string match
18552 base_beg : prefix match
18553 base_dir : subdir match
18554 base_dom : domain match
18555 base_end : suffix match
18556 base_len : length match
18557 base_reg : regex match
18558 base_sub : substring match
18559
18560base32 : integer
18561 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18562 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18563 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018564 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18565 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18566 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018567
18568base32+src : binary
18569 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18570 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18571 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18572 per-URL counters.
18573
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010018574baseq : string
18575 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18576 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
18577 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
18578 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
18579
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018580capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18581 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18582 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18583 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18584
18585capture.req.method : string
18586 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18587 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18588 because it's allocated.
18589
18590capture.req.uri : string
18591 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18592 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18593 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18594 allocated.
18595
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018596capture.req.ver : string
18597 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18598 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18599 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18600
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018601capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18602 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18603 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18604 The first entry is an index of 0.
18605 See also: "capture response header"
18606
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018607capture.res.ver : string
18608 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18609 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18610 persistent flag.
18611
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018612req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018613 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18614 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18615 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018616
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018617req.body_param([<name>) : string
18618 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18619 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18620 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18621 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18622 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18623 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18624 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18625 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18626 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18627 given.
18628
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018629req.body_len : integer
18630 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18631 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018632 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18633 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018634
18635req.body_size : integer
18636 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018637 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18638 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018640req.cook([<name>]) : string
18641cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18642 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18643 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18644 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18645 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18646 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18647 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18648 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18649 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18650
18651 ACL derivatives :
18652 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18653 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18654 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18655 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18656 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18657 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18658 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18659 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018661req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18662cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18663 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18664 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018666req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18667cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18668 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18669 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18670 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18671 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018673cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18674 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18675 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18676 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18677 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018678 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018679 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18680 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18681 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18682 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018684hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18685 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18686 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18687 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18688 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018689 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018691req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018692 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
18693 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
18694 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
18695 with headers such as User-Agent.
18696
18697 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
18698 found.
18699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018700 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18701 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18702 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018703 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018705req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18706 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18707 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018708 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
18709 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018711req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018712 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
18713 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
18714 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
18715 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
18716 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
18717 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
18718 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
18719
18720 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
18721 found.
18722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018723 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18724 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18725 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018726 with -1 being the last one.
18727
18728 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
18729 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018731 ACL derivatives :
18732 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18733 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18734 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18735 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18736 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18737 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18738 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18739 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18740
18741req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18742hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18743 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18744 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018745 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
18746 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
18747 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
18748
18749 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
18750 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
18751 which contain more than one of certain headers.
18752
18753 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018754
18755req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18756hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18757 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18758 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18759 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018760 of every header is checked.
18761
18762 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
18763
18764 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018765
18766req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18767hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18768 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18769 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18770 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018771
18772 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
18773
18774 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018775
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018776req.hdrs : string
18777 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
18778 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18779 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18780 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
18781
18782req.hdrs_bin : binary
18783 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18784 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
18785 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
18786 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
18787 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
18788 names and values (length of 0 for both).
18789
18790 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018791
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018792 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18793 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018795http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18796 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18797 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18798 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18799 basic auth is supported.
18800
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018801http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18802 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18803 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18804 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18805 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018806 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18807 basic auth is supported.
18808
18809 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018810 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18811 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18812 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18813 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018814
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018815http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018816 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18817 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18818 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018819
18820http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018821 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18822 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18823 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018824
18825http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018826 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18827 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18828 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018830http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018831 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18832 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018833 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18834 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018836method : integer + string
18837 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18838 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18839 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18840 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18841 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18842 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18843 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018845 ACL derivatives :
18846 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018848 Example :
18849 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18850 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18851 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018853path : string
18854 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18855 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18856 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18857 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18858 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018859 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018860 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018862 ACL derivatives :
18863 path : exact string match
18864 path_beg : prefix match
18865 path_dir : subdir match
18866 path_dom : domain match
18867 path_end : suffix match
18868 path_len : length match
18869 path_reg : regex match
18870 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018871
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018872pathq : string
18873 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18874 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18875 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18876 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18877 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18878 result in both cases.
18879
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018880query : string
18881 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18882 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18883 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18884 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018885 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018886 which stops before the question mark.
18887
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018888req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18889 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18890 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18891 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18892 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018894req.ver : string
18895req_ver : string (deprecated)
18896 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18897 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18898 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018900 ACL derivatives :
18901 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018902
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018903res.body : binary
18904 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18905 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018906 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18907
18908 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018909
18910res.body_len : integer
18911 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18912 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018913 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18914
18915 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018916
18917res.body_size : integer
18918 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18919 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18920 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18921 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018922 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18923
18924 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018925
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010018926res.cache_hit : boolean
18927 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
18928 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
18929
18930res.cache_name : string
18931 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
18932 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
18933 empty string.
18934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018935res.comp : boolean
18936 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18937 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18938 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018940res.comp_algo : string
18941 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18942 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18943 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018945res.cook([<name>]) : string
18946scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18947 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18948 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018949 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
18950
18951 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018953 ACL derivatives :
18954 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018956res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18957scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18958 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18959 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018960 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
18961
18962 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018964res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18965scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18966 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18967 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018968 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
18969
18970 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018972res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018973 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
18974 on the headers within an HTTP response.
18975
18976 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
18977 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
18978
18979 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
18980
18981 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018983res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018984 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
18985 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18986
18987 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
18988 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
18989
18990 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018992res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18993shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018994 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
18995 on the headers within an HTTP response.
18996
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050018997 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018998 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
18999
19000 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019002 ACL derivatives :
19003 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19004 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19005 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19006 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19007 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19008 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19009 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19010 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19011
19012res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19013shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019014 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19015 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19016
19017 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019018 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019019
19020 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019022res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19023shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019024 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19025 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19026
19027 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19028
19029 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019030
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019031res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19032 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19033 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19034 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019035 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19036
19037 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019039res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19040shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019041 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19042 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19043
19044 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19045
19046 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019047
19048res.hdrs : string
19049 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19050 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19051 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019052 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19053
19054 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019055
19056res.hdrs_bin : binary
19057 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19058 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19059 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19060 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19061 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19062 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19063 (length of 0 for both).
19064
19065 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19066
19067 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19068 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019070res.ver : string
19071resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19072 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019073 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19074
19075 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019077 ACL derivatives :
19078 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019080set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19081 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19082 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019083 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019084 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019086 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19087 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019089status : integer
19090 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19091 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019092 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19093
19094 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019095
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019096unique-id : string
19097 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19098 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19099 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19100 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19101 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19102 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019104url : string
19105 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19106 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19107 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19108 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19109 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19110 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19111 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019113 ACL derivatives :
19114 url : exact string match
19115 url_beg : prefix match
19116 url_dir : subdir match
19117 url_dom : domain match
19118 url_end : suffix match
19119 url_len : length match
19120 url_reg : regex match
19121 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019123url_ip : ip
19124 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19125 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19126 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19127 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19128 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19129 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19130 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019132url_port : integer
19133 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19134 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19135 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19136 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019137
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019138urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19139url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019140 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19141 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019142 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19143 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19144 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19145 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019146 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19147 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019148 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19149 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019151 ACL derivatives :
19152 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19153 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19154 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19155 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19156 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19157 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19158 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19159 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019160
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019162 Example :
19163 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19164 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19165 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19166 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019167
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019168urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019169 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19170 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19171 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019172
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019173url32 : integer
19174 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19175 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19176 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19177 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19178 is an unsigned integer.
19179
19180url32+src : binary
19181 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19182 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19183 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19184
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019185
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200191867.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019187---------------------------------------
19188
19189This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19190used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19191purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19192There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19193or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19194any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19195for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19196
19197internal.htx.data : integer
19198 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19199 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19200
19201internal.htx.free : integer
19202 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19203 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19204
19205internal.htx.free_data : integer
19206 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19207 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19208
19209internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019210 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19211 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19212 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019213
19214internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19215 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19216 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19217
19218internal.htx.size : integer
19219 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19220 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19221
19222internal.htx.used : integer
19223 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19224 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19225 direction.
19226
19227internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19228 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19229 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19230 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19231 of the special value :
19232 * head : The oldest inserted block
19233 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019234 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019235
19236internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19237 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19238 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19239 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19240 integer or one of the special value :
19241 * head : The oldest inserted block
19242 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019243 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019244
19245internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19246 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19247 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19248 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19249 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19250
19251 * head : The oldest inserted block
19252 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019253 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019254
19255internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19256 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19257 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19258 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19259 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19260
19261 * head : The oldest inserted block
19262 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019263 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019264
19265internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19266 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19267 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19268 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19269 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19270
19271 * head : The oldest inserted block
19272 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019273 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019274
19275internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19276 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19277 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19278 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19279 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19280
19281 * head : The oldest inserted block
19282 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019283 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019284
19285internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19286 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19287 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19288 it returns false.
19289
19290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200192917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019292---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019294Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19295every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019296order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019298ACL name Equivalent to Usage
19299---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019300FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020019301HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019302HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
19303HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019304HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
19305HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19306HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19307HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19308LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019309METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020019310METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019311METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19312METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19313METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19314METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020019315METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019316METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020019317RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019318REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019319TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019320WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19321---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019322
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019323
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193248. Logging
19325----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019326
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019327One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19328provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19329very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19330provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19331state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019332to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019333headers.
19334
19335In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19336about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19337send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19338
19339 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19340 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19341 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19342 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19343 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019344 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019345 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019346
19347The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19348allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19349as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19350while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19351real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19352delay.
19353
19354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193558.1. Log levels
19356---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019357
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019358TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019359source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019360HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19361in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19362track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19363syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19364about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019365
19366
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193678.2. Log formats
19368----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019369
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019370HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019371and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19372slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19373options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019374
19375 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19376 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19377 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19378 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19379 extents.
19380
19381 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19382 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19383 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19384 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19385 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19386
19387 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19388 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19389 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19390 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19391 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19392
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019393 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19394 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19395 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19396 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19397
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019398 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19399
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019400Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19401specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19402field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19403servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19404always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19405identifier.
19406
19407Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19408 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19409 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19410 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19411 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19412
19413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194148.2.1. Default log format
19415-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019416
19417This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19418as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19419format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19420
19421 Example :
19422 listen www
19423 mode http
19424 log global
19425 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19426
19427 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19428 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19429 (www/HTTP)
19430
19431 Field Format Extract from the example above
19432 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19433 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19434 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19435 4 'to' to
19436 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19437 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19438
19439Detailed fields description :
19440 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19441 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19442 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19443 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19444 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19445 and processed the connection.
19446 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19447
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019448In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19449"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19450connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19451
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019452It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19453will eventually disappear.
19454
19455
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194568.2.2. TCP log format
19457---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019458
19459The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19460is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19461information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19462counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19463emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19464environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19465the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19466sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019467specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19468not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19469fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19470marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019471
19472 Example :
19473 frontend fnt
19474 mode tcp
19475 option tcplog
19476 log global
19477 default_backend bck
19478
19479 backend bck
19480 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19481
19482 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19483 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19484 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19485
19486 Field Format Extract from the example above
19487 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19488 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19489 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19490 4 frontend_name fnt
19491 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19492 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19493 7 bytes_read* 212
19494 8 termination_state --
19495 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19496 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19497
19498Detailed fields description :
19499 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019500 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19501 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19502 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019503 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019504 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019505 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019506
19507 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019508 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19509 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19510 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019511
19512 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19513 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19514 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019515 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19516 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19517 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19518 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019519
19520 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19521 and processed the connection.
19522
19523 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19524 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19525 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19526 applications.
19527
19528 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19529 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19530 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19531 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19532 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19533
19534 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19535 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19536 See "Timers" below for more details.
19537
19538 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19539 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19540 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19541 "Timers" below for more details.
19542
19543 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019544 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019545 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19546 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19547 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19548 details.
19549
19550 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19551 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19552 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19553 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19554 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19555
19556 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19557 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19558 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19559 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19560 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19561 for more details.
19562
19563 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019564 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019565 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19566 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19567 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019568 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019569
19570 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19571 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19572 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19573 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19574 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19575 caused by a denial of service attack.
19576
19577 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19578 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19579 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19580 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19581 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19582 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19583 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19584 denial of service attack.
19585
19586 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19587 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19588 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19589 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19590 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19591 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19592 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19593 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19594 be processed than on other servers.
19595
19596 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19597 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19598 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19599 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19600 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19601 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19602 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19603 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19604 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19605 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19606 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19607 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19608 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19609
19610 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19611 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19612 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19613 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19614 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19615 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019616 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019617 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19618
19619 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19620 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19621 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19622 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19623 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19624 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019625 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019626 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19627 occurs.
19628
19629
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196308.2.3. HTTP log format
19631----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019632
19633The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19634is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19635the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19636are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19637emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19638generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19639"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19640which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019641frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19642is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019643
19644Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19645slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19646with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19647
19648 Example :
19649 frontend http-in
19650 mode http
19651 option httplog
19652 log global
19653 default_backend bck
19654
19655 backend static
19656 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19657
19658 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19659 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19660 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019661 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019662
19663 Field Format Extract from the example above
19664 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19665 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019666 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019667 4 frontend_name http-in
19668 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019669 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019670 7 status_code 200
19671 8 bytes_read* 2750
19672 9 captured_request_cookie -
19673 10 captured_response_cookie -
19674 11 termination_state ----
19675 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19676 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19677 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19678 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19679 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019680
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019681Detailed fields description :
19682 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019683 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19684 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19685 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019686 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019687 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019688 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019689
19690 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019691 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19692 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19693 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019694
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019695 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
19696 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019697
19698 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19699 and processed the connection.
19700
19701 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19702 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19703 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
19704
19705 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19706 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19707 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19708 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
19709 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
19710 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
19711
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019712 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
19713 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
19714 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019715 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019716 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
19717 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019718 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
19719 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019720
19721 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19722 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019723 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019724
19725 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19726 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019727 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
19728 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019729
19730 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
19731 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
19732 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
19733 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
19734 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019735 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
19736 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019737
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019738 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
19739 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
19740 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
19741 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
19742 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
19743 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
19744 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019745 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019746
19747 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19748 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19749 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19750
19751 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19752 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019753 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019754 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19755 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19756 overflowing.
19757
19758 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19759 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19760 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19761 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19762 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19763 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19764 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19765 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19766
19767 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19768 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19769 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19770 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19771 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19772 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19773 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19774 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19775
19776 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19777 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19778 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19779 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19780 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19781 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19782 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19783
19784 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019785 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019786 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19787 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19788 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019789 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019790 system.
19791
19792 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19793 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19794 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19795 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19796 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19797 caused by a denial of service attack.
19798
19799 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19800 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19801 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19802 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19803 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19804 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19805 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19806 denial of service attack.
19807
19808 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19809 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19810 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19811 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19812 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19813 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19814 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19815 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19816 processed than on other servers.
19817
19818 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19819 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19820 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19821 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19822 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19823 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19824 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19825 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19826 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19827 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19828 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19829 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19830 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19831
19832 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19833 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19834 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19835 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19836 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19837 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019838 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019839 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19840
19841 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19842 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19843 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19844 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19845 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19846 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019847 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019848 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19849 occurs.
19850
19851 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19852 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19853 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19854 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19855 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19856 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19857 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19858 cookies" below for more details.
19859
19860 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19861 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19862 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19863 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19864 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19865 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19866 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19867 and cookies" below for more details.
19868
19869 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19870 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19871 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19872 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19873 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19874 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19875 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19876 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19877
19878
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200198798.2.4. Custom log format
19880------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019881
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019882The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019883mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019884
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019885HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019886Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19887separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19888prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19889
19890Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19891variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019892("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019893
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019894If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019895as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019896less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19897the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19898
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019899Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19900"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19901delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19902preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019903
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019904Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19905'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19906https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19907such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19908
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019909Flags are :
19910 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019911 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019912 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19913 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019914
19915 Example:
19916
19917 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19918 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19919
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019920 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19921
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019922At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19923
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019924 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19925 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019926
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019927the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019928
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019929 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19930 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19931 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019932
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019933and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19934
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019935 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19936 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019937
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019938Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19939
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019940 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019941 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019942 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19943 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19944 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019945 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19946 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19947 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019948 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019949 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000019950 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000019951 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019952 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019953 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19954 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019955 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019956 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019957 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019958 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019959 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019960 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019961 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019962 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19963 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19964 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19965 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19966 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019967 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019968 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019969 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019970 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019971 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019972 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19973 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019974 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19975 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19976 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019977 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019978 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19979 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019980 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019981 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19982 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19983 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019984 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019985 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019986 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19987 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19988 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19989 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019990 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019991 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019992 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019993 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019994 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019995 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019996 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19997 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19998 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019999 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020000 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20001 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020002 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020003 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20004 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020005 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020006 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020007 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020008 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020009
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020010 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020011
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020012
200138.2.5. Error log format
20014-----------------------
20015
20016When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
20017protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
20018By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20019"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020020will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020021logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20022
20023The format looks like this :
20024
20025 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20026 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20027 Connection error during SSL handshake
20028
20029 Field Format Extract from the example above
20030 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20031 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20032 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20033 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20034 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20035
20036These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20037failures.
20038
20039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200408.3. Advanced logging options
20041-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020042
20043Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20044just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20045options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20046for more information about their usage.
20047
20048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200498.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20050------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020051
20052It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
20053haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
20054commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20055monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20056ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20057
20058 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20059 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20060 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20061 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20062
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020063 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20064 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020065
20066 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20067 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20068 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20069
20070
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200718.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20072----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020073
20074The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20075what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20076or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020077"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020078just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20079log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20080after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20081is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20082with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20083with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20084
20085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200868.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20087------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020088
20089Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20090for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20091"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20092retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20093raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20094a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20095file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20096you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20097"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20098
20099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201008.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20101--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020102
20103Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20104multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20105them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20106"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20107logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20108error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20109and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20110too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20111useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20112alternative.
20113
20114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201158.4. Timing events
20116------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020117
20118Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20119reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20120the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20121frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020122mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20123addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20124
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020125Timings events in HTTP mode:
20126
20127 first request 2nd request
20128 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20129 t tr t tr ...
20130 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20131 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20132 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20133 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020134 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020135 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20136
20137Timings events in TCP mode:
20138
20139 TCP session
20140 |<----------------->|
20141 t t
20142 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20143 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20144 |<------ Tt ------->|
20145
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020146 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020147 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020148 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20149 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20150 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020151 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020152 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20153 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20154 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20155 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020156
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020157 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20158 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20159 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020160 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20161 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20162 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20163 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20164 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20165 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020166
20167 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20168 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20169 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20170 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20171 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20172 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20173 request typed by hand during a test.
20174
20175 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20176 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020177 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020178 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20179 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20180 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20181 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020182
20183 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20184 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20185 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20186 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20187 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20188
20189 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20190 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20191 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20192 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20193 connection never established.
20194
20195 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20196 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20197 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20198 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20199 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20200 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20201 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20202 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20203 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20204 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20205 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20206
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020207 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20208 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20209 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20210 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20211 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20212 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20213
20214 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20215
20216 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20217 "Ta" can never be negative.
20218
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020219 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20220 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020221 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20222 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020223 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020224
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020225 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020226
20227 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020228 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20229 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020230
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020231 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20232 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20233 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20234 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20235 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20236 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20237 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20238 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20239
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020240These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20241protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20242that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020243due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20244"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20245that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020246
20247Most common cases :
20248
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020249 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20250 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20251 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20252 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20253 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
20254 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
20255 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20256 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20257 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20258 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20259 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020260 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020261
20262 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20263 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20264 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20265 of ms on remote networks.
20266
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020267 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20268 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20269 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020270
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020271 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20272 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20273 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20274 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20275 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20276 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20277 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20278 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20279 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020280
20281Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20282
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020283 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020284 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020285 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020286
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020287 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020288 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20289 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20290
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020291 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020292 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20293 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20294 flags.
20295
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020296 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20297 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020298 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20299 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20300 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20301 the client connection was maintained open.
20302
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020303 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020304 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020305 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020306 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20307
20308
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203098.5. Session state at disconnection
20310-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020311
20312TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20313"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
203142-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20315each of which has a special meaning :
20316
20317 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20318 session to terminate :
20319
20320 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20321
20322 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20323 server explicitly refused it.
20324
20325 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20326 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20327 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20328 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020329 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020330
20331 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20332 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020333
20334 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20335 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20336 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20337 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20338 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20339
20340 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20341 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20342 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20343 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20344 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20345
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020346 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20347 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20348
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020349 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20350 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20351 backup connections when going up.
20352
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020353 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20354
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020355 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20356 send or receive data.
20357
20358 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20359 send or receive data.
20360
20361 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20362 with nothing left in the buffers.
20363
20364 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20365
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020366 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020367 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20368
20369 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20370 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20371 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20372 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20373 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20374
20375 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20376 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20377
20378 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20379 server (HTTP only).
20380
20381 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20382
20383 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20384 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20385 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20386
20387 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20388 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20389 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20390
20391 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20392
20393 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20394 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20395
20396 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20397 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20398 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20399
20400 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20401 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020402 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20403 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020404
20405 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20406 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20407 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20408 another server.
20409
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020410 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020411 server.
20412
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020413 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20414 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20415 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20416 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20417
20418 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20419 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20420 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20421 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20422
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020423 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20424 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20425 "use-server" rule).
20426
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020427 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20428
20429 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20430 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20431
20432 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20433
20434 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20435 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20436 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20437
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020438 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20439 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020440 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020441 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20442 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20443
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020444 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20445
20446 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20447 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20448
20449 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20450
20451 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20452
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020453The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20454was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020455helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20456starvation, attacks, etc...
20457
20458The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20459alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20460easier finding and understanding.
20461
20462 Flags Reason
20463
20464 -- Normal termination.
20465
20466 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20467 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20468 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20469 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20470
20471 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20472 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20473 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20474 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20475 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20476 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020477
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020478 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20479 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020480 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020481
20482 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20483 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20484 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20485
20486 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20487 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20488 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20489 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20490 the server takes too long to respond.
20491
20492 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20493 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20494 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20495 long a time to respond.
20496
20497 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20498 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20499 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20500 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020501 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20502 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020503
20504 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20505 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20506 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20507 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20508 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020509 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020510 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20511 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20512 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20513 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20514 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20515 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20516 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20517 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020518 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020519 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20520 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20521 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020522
20523 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20524 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020525 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20526 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20527 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20528 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020529
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020530 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20531 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20532
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020533 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020534 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20535 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020536 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020537 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20538 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20539
20540 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20541 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20542 503 or 504 here.
20543
20544 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20545 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20546 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20547 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20548 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20549
20550 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20551 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020552 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020553 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20554 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20555
20556 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20557 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20558 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20559 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20560 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20561 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20562 between haproxy and the server.
20563
20564 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20565 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20566 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20567 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20568 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20569 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20570 solution is to fix the application.
20571
20572 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20573 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20574 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20575 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20576 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20577 external attacks.
20578
20579 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070020580 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020581 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020582 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20583 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20584
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020585 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20586 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20587 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020588 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020589 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020590
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020591 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20592 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20593 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20594 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020595 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20596 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20597 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20598 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20599 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020600
20601 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20602 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20603 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20604 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20605
20606 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20607 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20608 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20609 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20610
20611 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20612 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20613 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20614 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20615
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020616The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20617persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20618important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20619re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20620
20621 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20622
20623 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20624 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20625 set on a GET request.
20626
20627 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20628 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020629 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020630 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20631
20632 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20633 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20634 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20635
20636 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20637 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20638 already got a cookie.
20639
20640 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20641 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20642 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20643 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20644 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20645
20646 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20647 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20648 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20649
20650 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20651 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20652 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20653
20654 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20655 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20656
20657 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20658 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20659 then advertised in the response.
20660
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020661
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206628.6. Non-printable characters
20663-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020664
20665In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20666consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20667converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20668prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20669being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20670escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20671is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20672'}' when logging headers.
20673
20674Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20675issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20676containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20677
20678Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20679the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20680performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20681
20682
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206838.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20684---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020685
20686Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20687achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020688section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020689cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20690the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20691the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020692locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020693not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20694user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20695a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
20696wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
20697
20698 Examples :
20699 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
20700 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
20701
20702 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
20703 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
20704
20705
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207068.8. Capturing HTTP headers
20707---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020708
20709Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
20710proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
20711the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
20712server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
20713
20714Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
20715response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020716section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020717
20718It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020719time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
20720appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020721are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
20722and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
20723follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
20724request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
20725in the logs.
20726
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020727As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
20728frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
20729an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
20730
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020731 Example :
20732 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
20733 listen proxy-out
20734 mode http
20735 option httplog
20736 option logasap
20737 log global
20738 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
20739
20740 # log the name of the virtual server
20741 capture request header Host len 20
20742
20743 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
20744 capture request header Content-Length len 10
20745
20746 # log the beginning of the referrer
20747 capture request header Referer len 20
20748
20749 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20750 capture response header Server len 20
20751
20752 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20753 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20754
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020755 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020756 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20757
20758 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20759 capture response header Via len 20
20760
20761 # log the URL location during a redirection
20762 capture response header Location len 20
20763
20764 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20765 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20766 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20767 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20768 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20769
20770 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20771 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20772 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20773 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020774 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020775
20776 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20777 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20778 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20779 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20780 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020781 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020782
20783
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207848.9. Examples of logs
20785---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020786
20787These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20788them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20789reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20790
20791 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20792 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20793 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20794
20795 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20796 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20797
20798 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20799 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20800 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20801
20802 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20803 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20804
20805 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20806 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20807 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20808
20809 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020810 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020811 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20812 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20813
20814 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20815 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20816 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20817
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020818 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20819 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20820 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20821 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20822 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20823 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020824
20825 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020826 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020827
20828 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20829 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20830 Nothing was sent to any server.
20831
20832 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20833 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20834
20835 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20836 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020837 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020838 send a 408 return code to the client.
20839
20840 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20841 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20842
20843 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20844 5 seconds ("c----").
20845
20846 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20847 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020848 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020849
20850 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020851 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020852 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20853 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20854 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20855 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20856 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020857
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020858
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200208599. Supported filters
20860--------------------
20861
20862Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20863accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20864unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20865
20866See also : "filter"
20867
208689.1. Trace
20869----------
20870
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010020871filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020872
20873 Arguments:
20874 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20875 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20876
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010020877 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020878
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020879 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020880 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20881 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20882 amount of the parsed data.
20883
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020884 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020885
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020886This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20887callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20888information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20889filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20890
20891Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20892tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20893a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20894
20895
208969.2. HTTP compression
20897---------------------
20898
20899filter compression
20900
20901The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20902keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020903when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20904fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20905done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20906explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20907filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20908listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20909order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020910
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020911See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20912 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020913
20914
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200209159.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20916--------------------------------------------
20917
20918filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20919
20920 Arguments :
20921
20922 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20923 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20924 parsed.
20925
20926 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20927 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20928 part must be placed in its own scope.
20929
20930The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20931external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020932streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020933exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20934also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20935
20936SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20937the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20938
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020939For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020940"doc/SPOE.txt".
20941
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100209429.4. Cache
20943----------
20944
20945filter cache <name>
20946
20947 Arguments :
20948
20949 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20950
20951The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20952"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020953cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020954other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20955case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20956is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20957filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020958listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20959order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020960
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020961See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20962 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20963
20964
209659.5. Fcgi-app
20966-------------
20967
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020968filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020969
20970 Arguments :
20971
20972 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20973
20974The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20975request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20976reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20977used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20978implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20979used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20980fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20981used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20982order.
20983
20984See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20985 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20986
20987
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100209889.6. OpenTracing
20989----------------
20990
20991The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
20992HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
20993of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
20994Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
20995
20996This feature is only enabled when haproxy was built with USE_OT=1.
20997
20998The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
20999HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21000participates in the work of HAProxy.
21001
21002filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21003
21004 Arguments :
21005
21006 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21007 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21008 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21009 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21010 OpenTracing filters.
21011
21012 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21013 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21014 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21015 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21016 filter must have its own scope defined.
21017
21018More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
21019of the filter can be found in the contrib/opentracing directory.
21020
21021
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002102210. FastCGI applications
21023-------------------------
21024
21025HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21026feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21027the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21028FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21029servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21030FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21031backend.
21032
21033HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21034application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21035connection.
21036
2103710.1. Setup
21038-----------
21039
2104010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21041--------------------------
21042
21043fcgi-app <name>
21044 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21045 document root must be defined.
21046
21047acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21048 Declare or complete an access list.
21049
21050 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21051 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21052 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21053 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21054 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21055
21056docroot <path>
21057 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21058 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21059 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21060
21061index <script-name>
21062 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21063 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21064 is an optional setting.
21065
21066 Example :
21067 index index.php
21068
21069log-stderr global
21070log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021071 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021072 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21073
21074 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21075 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21076
21077pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21078 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21079 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21080 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21081
21082 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21083 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21084 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21085 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21086
21087 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21088 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21089
21090path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021091 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021092 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21093 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21094 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21095 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21096 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21097 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21098 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021099
21100 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021101 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021102 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21103 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21104 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21105 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021106
21107 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021108 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21109 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021110
21111option get-values
21112no option get-values
21113 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21114
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021115 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021116 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21117
21118 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21119 application will accept.
21120
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021121 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21122 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021123
21124 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021125 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021126 option is disabled.
21127
21128 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21129 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21130 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21131 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21132 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21133 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21134
21135option keep-conn
21136no option keep-conn
21137 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21138 sending a response.
21139
21140 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21141 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21142
21143option max-reqs <reqs>
21144 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21145 accept.
21146
21147 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21148 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21149 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21150 to 1.
21151
21152option mpxs-conns
21153no option mpxs-conns
21154 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21155
21156 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21157 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21158
21159set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21160 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21161 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21162 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21163 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21164
21165 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21166 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21167 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21168
21169 Example :
21170 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21171 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21172
21173 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21174
21175
2117610.1.2. Proxy section
21177---------------------
21178
21179use-fcgi-app <name>
21180 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21181
21182 Arguments :
21183 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21184
21185 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21186 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21187 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21188 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21189 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21190
21191 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21192 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21193 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21194 application are evaluated.
21195
21196
2119710.1.3. Example
21198---------------
21199
21200 frontend front-http
21201 mode http
21202 bind *:80
21203 bind *:
21204
21205 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21206 default_backend back-static
21207
21208 backend back-static
21209 mode http
21210 server www A.B.C.D:80
21211
21212 backend back-dynamic
21213 mode http
21214 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21215 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21216
21217 fcgi-app php-fpm
21218 log-stderr global
21219 option keep-conn
21220
21221 docroot /var/www/my-app
21222 index index.php
21223 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21224
21225
2122610.2. Default parameters
21227------------------------
21228
21229A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21230the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021231script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021232applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21233
21234 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21235 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21236 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21237 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21238 | | |
21239 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21240 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21241 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21242 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21243 | | application. |
21244 | | |
21245 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21246 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21247 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21248 | | |
21249 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21250 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21251 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21252 | | the application's configuration. |
21253 | | |
21254 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21255 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21256 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21257 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21258 | | |
21259 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21260 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21261 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21262 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21263 | | be defined. |
21264 | | |
21265 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21266 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21267 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21268 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21269 | | is not set too. |
21270 | | |
21271 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21272 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21273 | | set. |
21274 | | |
21275 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21276 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21277 | | the request. |
21278 | | |
21279 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21280 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21281 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21282 | | |
21283 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21284 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21285 | | script to process the request. |
21286 | | |
21287 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21288 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21289 | | |
21290 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21291 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21292 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21293 | | |
21294 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21295 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21296 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21297 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21298 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21299 | | |
21300 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21301 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21302 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21303 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21304 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21305 | | side. |
21306 | | |
21307 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21308 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21309 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21310 | | connected to. |
21311 | | |
21312 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21313 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21314 | | |
21315 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21316 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21317 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21318 | | |
21319 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21320
21321
2132210.3. Limitations
21323------------------
21324
21325The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21326way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21327during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21328establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21329application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21330or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21331message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21332these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21333and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21334
21335Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21336request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21337requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21338
21339About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21340into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21341fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21342"http-request" ones.
21343
21344Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21345FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21346processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21347must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21348here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021349
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021350/*
21351 * Local variables:
21352 * fill-column: 79
21353 * End:
21354 */